blob: 782bda9e816050e94a62dcf3778af4417df3c690 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau9eeb57b2012-03-26 06:15:29 +02007 2012/03/24
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020050
514. Proxies
524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
54
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100555. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
576. HTTP header manipulation
58
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200607.1. Matching integers
617.2. Matching strings
627.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
637.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
647.5. Available matching criteria
657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
667.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
677.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
697.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100707.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
728. Logging
738.1. Log levels
748.2. Log formats
758.2.1. Default log format
768.2.2. TCP log format
778.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100788.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200798.3. Advanced logging options
808.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
818.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
828.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
838.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
848.4. Timing events
858.5. Session state at disconnection
868.6. Non-printable characters
878.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
888.8. Capturing HTTP headers
898.9. Examples of logs
90
919. Statistics and monitoring
929.1. CSV format
939.2. Unix Socket commands
94
95
961. Quick reminder about HTTP
97----------------------------
98
99When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
100fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
101on almost anything found in the contents.
102
103However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
104formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
105correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
106
107
1081.1. The HTTP transaction model
109-------------------------------
110
111The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100112to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200113from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
114connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
115will involve a new connection :
116
117 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
118
119In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
120establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
121by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
122length.
123
124Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
125to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
126however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
127response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
128header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
129
130 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
131
132Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
133power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
134but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200135a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
137A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
138keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
139second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
140page :
141
142 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
143
144This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
145latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
146correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
147the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100148server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200150By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
151connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
152everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
153established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
154sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
155while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
156another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
157sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
158http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
159mode.
160
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161
1621.2. HTTP request
163-----------------
164
165First, let's consider this HTTP request :
166
167 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100168 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
170 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
171 3 User-agent: my small browser
172 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
173 5 Accept: image/png
174
175
1761.2.1. The Request line
177-----------------------
178
179Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
180
181 - a METHOD : GET
182 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
183 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
184
185All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
186which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
187followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
188is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
189desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
190the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
191
192The URI itself can have several forms :
193
194 - A "relative URI" :
195
196 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
197
198 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
199 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
200
201 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
202
203 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
204
205 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
206 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
207 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
208 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
209 must accept this form too.
210
211 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
212 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
213 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100214
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
216 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
217 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
218 other protocols too.
219
220In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
221mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
222on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
223It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
224specific to the language, framework or application in use.
225
226
2271.2.2. The request headers
228--------------------------
229
230The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
231beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
232an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
233Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
234values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
235encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
236the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
237define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
238
239Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
240their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
241"Connection:" header).
242
243The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
244that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
245is one valid form of empty line.
246
247Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
248headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
249about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
250application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
251
252Important note:
253 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
254 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
255 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
256 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
257
258
2591.3. HTTP response
260------------------
261
262An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
263messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
264
265 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100266 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200267 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
268 2 Content-length: 350
269 3 Content-Type: text/html
270
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200271As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
272codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
273response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100274continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
275the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
276following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
277sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
278(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
279correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
280such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
281state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
282over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
283if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
284information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200286
2871.3.1. The Response line
288------------------------
289
290Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
291
292 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
293 - a status code : 200
294 - a reason : OK
295
296The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200297 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
299 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
300 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
301 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
302
303Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100304"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200305found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
306messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
307or "Authentication Required".
308
309Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
310
311 Code When / reason
312 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
313 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
314 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
316 400 for an invalid or too large request
317 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
318 accessing the stats page)
319 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
320 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
321 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
322 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
323 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
324 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
325 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
326 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
327 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
328
329The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3304.2).
331
332
3331.3.2. The response headers
334---------------------------
335
336Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
337the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
338details.
339
340
3412. Configuring HAProxy
342----------------------
343
3442.1. Configuration file format
345------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200346
347HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
348
349 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
350 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
351 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
352 "frontend" and "backend".
353
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100354The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
355referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
356delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100357preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100358escaped by doubling them.
359
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
3612.2. Time format
362----------------
363
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100364Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100365values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
366otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
367numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
368for every keyword. Supported units are :
369
370 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
371 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
372 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
373 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
374 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
375 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
376
377
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003782.3. Examples
379-------------
380
381 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
382 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
383 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
384 global
385 daemon
386 maxconn 256
387
388 defaults
389 mode http
390 timeout connect 5000ms
391 timeout client 50000ms
392 timeout server 50000ms
393
394 frontend http-in
395 bind *:80
396 default_backend servers
397
398 backend servers
399 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
400
401
402 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
403 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
404 global
405 daemon
406 maxconn 256
407
408 defaults
409 mode http
410 timeout connect 5000ms
411 timeout client 50000ms
412 timeout server 50000ms
413
414 listen http-in
415 bind *:80
416 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
417
418
419Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
420
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100421 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200422
423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004243. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200425--------------------
426
427Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
428are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
429of them have command-line equivalents.
430
431The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
432
433 * Process management and security
434 - chroot
435 - daemon
436 - gid
437 - group
438 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100439 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200440 - nbproc
441 - pidfile
442 - uid
443 - ulimit-n
444 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200445 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200446 - node
447 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100448 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100449
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 * Performance tuning
451 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200452 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100453 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200454 - noepoll
455 - nokqueue
456 - nopoll
457 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100458 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200459 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200460 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200461 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200462 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100463 - tune.maxaccept
464 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200465 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200466 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100467 - tune.rcvbuf.client
468 - tune.rcvbuf.server
469 - tune.sndbuf.client
470 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100471
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200472 * Debugging
473 - debug
474 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200475
476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004773.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200478------------------------------------
479
480chroot <jail dir>
481 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
482 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
483 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
484 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
485 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
486 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100487
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200488daemon
489 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
490 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
491 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
492
493gid <number>
494 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
495 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
496 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
497 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100498
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200499group <group name>
500 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
501 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100502
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200503log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
505 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100506 configured with "log global".
507
508 <address> can be one of:
509
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100510 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100511 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
512 port).
513
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100514 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
515 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
516 port).
517
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100518 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
519 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
520 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
521 writeable).
522
523 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200524
525 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
526 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
527 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
528
529 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200530 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
531 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
532 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
533 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
534 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
535 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200536
537 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
538
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100539log-send-hostname [<string>]
540 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
541 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
542 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
543 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
544 the logs.
545
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000546log-tag <string>
547 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
548 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
549 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
550 running on the same host.
551
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200552nbproc <number>
553 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
554 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
555 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
556 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
557 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
558
559pidfile <pidfile>
560 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
561 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
562 starting the process. See also "daemon".
563
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200564stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200565 [level <level>]
566
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200567 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
568 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100569 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200570 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
571
572 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
573 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
574 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
575 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
576 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
577
578 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200579 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200580 counters).
581
582 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
583 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100584
585 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
586 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
587 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
588 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
589 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
590 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
591 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200592
593stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
594 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
595 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100596 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200597
598stats maxconn <connections>
599 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
600 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
601
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200602uid <number>
603 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
604 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
605 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
606 one. See also "gid" and "user".
607
608ulimit-n <number>
609 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
610 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
611 option.
612
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100613unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
614 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
615
616 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
617 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
618 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
619 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
620 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
621 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
622 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
623 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
624 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
625 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
626
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627user <user name>
628 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
629 See also "uid" and "group".
630
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200631node <name>
632 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
633
634 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
635 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
636 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
637 traffic.
638
639description <text>
640 Add a text that describes the instance.
641
642 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
643 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
644 "<" and ">" characters.
645
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006473.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648-----------------------
649
650maxconn <number>
651 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
652 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
653 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
654 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
655
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200656maxconnrate <number>
657 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
658 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
659 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
660 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
661 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
662 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
663 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
664 fairness.
665
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100666maxpipes <number>
667 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
668 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
669 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
670 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
671 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
672 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
673
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674noepoll
675 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
676 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
677 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
678
679nokqueue
680 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
681 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
682 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
683
684nopoll
685 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
686 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100687 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200688 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
689 "nokqueue".
690
691nosepoll
692 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
693 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
694 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
695
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100696nosplice
697 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
698 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
699 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100700 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100701 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
702 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
703 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
704 "option splice-response".
705
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200706spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
707 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
708 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
709 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
710 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
711 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
712
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200713tune.bufsize <number>
714 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
715 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
716 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
717 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
718 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
719 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
720 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
721 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
722
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200723tune.chksize <number>
724 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
725 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
726 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
727 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
728 checks whenever possible.
729
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200730tune.http.maxhdr <number>
731 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
732 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
733 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
734 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
735 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
736 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
737 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
738 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
739 limit too high.
740
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100741tune.maxaccept <number>
742 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
743 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
744 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100745 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100746 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
747 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100748 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100749 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
750
751tune.maxpollevents <number>
752 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
753 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
754 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
755 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
756 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
757
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200758tune.maxrewrite <number>
759 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
760 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
761 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
762 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
763 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
764 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
765 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
766 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
767 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
768 bufsize.
769
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200770tune.pipesize <number>
771 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
772 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
773 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
774 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
775 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
776 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
777
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100778tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
779tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
780 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
781 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
782 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
783 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
784 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
785 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
786 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
787
788tune.sndbuf.client <number>
789tune.sndbuf.server <number>
790 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
791 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
792 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
793 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
794 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
795 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
796 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
797 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
798 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
799 notifying haproxy again.
800
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200801
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008023.3. Debugging
803--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200804
805debug
806 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
807 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
808 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
809 system startup.
810
811quiet
812 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
813 line argument "-q".
814
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200815
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008163.4. Userlists
817--------------
818It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
819http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
820it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
821
822userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100823 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100824 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
825
826group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100827 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100828 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
829 proceeded by "users" keyword.
830
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100831user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
832 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100833 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
834 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100835 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
836 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100837 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
838 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
839
840
841 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100842 userlist L1
843 group G1 users tiger,scott
844 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100845
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100846 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
847 user scott insecure-password elgato
848 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100849
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100850 userlist L2
851 group G1
852 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100853
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100854 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
855 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
856 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100857
858 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200859
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200860
8613.5. Peers
862--------------
863It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
864haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
865pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
866identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
867or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
868Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
869known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
870the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
871process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
872during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
873tables.
874
875peers <peersect>
876 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independant section,
877 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
878
879peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
880 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
881 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
882 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
883 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
884 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
885 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
886
887 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
888 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
889
890 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
891 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
892 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
893 across all peers.
894
895Example:
896 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100897 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
898 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
899 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200900
901 backend mybackend
902 mode tcp
903 balance roundrobin
904 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
905 stick on src
906
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100907 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
908 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200909
910
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009114. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200912----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100913
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200914Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
915 - defaults <name>
916 - frontend <name>
917 - backend <name>
918 - listen <name>
919
920A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
921its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
922section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100923section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200924
925A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
926connections.
927
928A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
929to forward incoming connections.
930
931A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
932parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
933
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100934All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
935'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
936case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
937
938Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
939logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
940proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
941However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
942name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
943
944Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
945and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100946bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100947protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
948modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
949arbitrary criteria.
950
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100951
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
953--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100954
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200955The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
956limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
957they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
958limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100959marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200960option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200961and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
962with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
963specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100964
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100966 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
967------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
968acl - X X X
969appsession - - X X
970backlog X X X -
971balance X - X X
972bind - X X -
973bind-process X X X X
974block - X X X
975capture cookie - X X -
976capture request header - X X -
977capture response header - X X -
978clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
979contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
980cookie X - X X
981default-server X - X X
982default_backend X X X -
983description - X X X
984disabled X X X X
985dispatch - - X X
986enabled X X X X
987errorfile X X X X
988errorloc X X X X
989errorloc302 X X X X
990-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
991errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200992force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100993fullconn X - X X
994grace X X X X
995hash-type X - X X
996http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100997http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200998http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100999http-request - X X X
1000id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001001ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001002log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001003maxconn X X X -
1004mode X X X X
1005monitor fail - X X -
1006monitor-net X X X -
1007monitor-uri X X X -
1008option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1009option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1010option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1011option allbackups (*) X - X X
1012option checkcache (*) X - X X
1013option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1014option contstats (*) X X X -
1015option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1016option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1017option forceclose (*) X X X X
1018-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1019option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001020option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001021option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001022option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1023option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1024option httpchk X - X X
1025option httpclose (*) X X X X
1026option httplog X X X X
1027option http_proxy (*) X X X X
1028option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001029option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001030option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1031option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1032option logasap (*) X X X -
1033option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001034option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001035option nolinger (*) X X X X
1036option originalto X X X X
1037option persist (*) X - X X
1038option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001039option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001040option smtpchk X - X X
1041option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1042option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1043option splice-request (*) X X X X
1044option splice-response (*) X X X X
1045option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1046option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1047-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1048option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1049option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1050option tcpka X X X X
1051option tcplog X X X X
1052option transparent (*) X - X X
1053persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1054rate-limit sessions X X X -
1055redirect - X X X
1056redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1057redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1058reqadd - X X X
1059reqallow - X X X
1060reqdel - X X X
1061reqdeny - X X X
1062reqiallow - X X X
1063reqidel - X X X
1064reqideny - X X X
1065reqipass - X X X
1066reqirep - X X X
1067reqisetbe - X X X
1068reqitarpit - X X X
1069reqpass - X X X
1070reqrep - X X X
1071-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1072reqsetbe - X X X
1073reqtarpit - X X X
1074retries X - X X
1075rspadd - X X X
1076rspdel - X X X
1077rspdeny - X X X
1078rspidel - X X X
1079rspideny - X X X
1080rspirep - X X X
1081rsprep - X X X
1082server - - X X
1083source X - X X
1084srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001085stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001086stats auth X - X X
1087stats enable X - X X
1088stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001089stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001090stats realm X - X X
1091stats refresh X - X X
1092stats scope X - X X
1093stats show-desc X - X X
1094stats show-legends X - X X
1095stats show-node X - X X
1096stats uri X - X X
1097-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1098stick match - - X X
1099stick on - - X X
1100stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001101stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001102stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001103tcp-request connection - X X -
1104tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001105tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001106tcp-response content - - X X
1107tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001108timeout check X - X X
1109timeout client X X X -
1110timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1111timeout connect X - X X
1112timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1113timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1114timeout http-request X X X X
1115timeout queue X - X X
1116timeout server X - X X
1117timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1118timeout tarpit X X X X
1119transparent (deprecated) X - X X
1120use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001121use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001122------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1123 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001124
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011264.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1127---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001128
1129This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1130
1131
1132acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1133 Declare or complete an access list.
1134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1135 no | yes | yes | yes
1136 Example:
1137 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1138 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1139 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1140
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001141 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001142
1143
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001144appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1145 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001146 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1148 no | no | yes | yes
1149 Arguments :
1150 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1151 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1152
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001153 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001154 checked in each cookie value.
1155
1156 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1157 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1158 milliseconds.
1159
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001160 request-learn
1161 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1162 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1163 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1164 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1165 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1166 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1167
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001168 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1169 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1170 data following this prefix.
1171
1172 Example :
1173 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1174
1175 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1176 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1177
1178 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1179 2 modes are currently supported :
1180 - path-parameters :
1181 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1182 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1183 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1184 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1185 - query-string :
1186 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1187 query string.
1188
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001189 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1190 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1191 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1192 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001193 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1194 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1195 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001196 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1197 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1198
1199 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1200
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001201 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1202 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1203 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1204
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001205 Example :
1206 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1207
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001208 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1209 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001210
1211
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001212backlog <conns>
1213 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1215 yes | yes | yes | no
1216 Arguments :
1217 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1218 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
1219 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
1220
1221 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1222 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1223 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1224 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1225 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1226 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1227 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1228 backlog parameter.
1229
1230 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1231 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1232 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1233
1234 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1235
1236
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001237balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001238balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001239 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1241 yes | no | yes | yes
1242 Arguments :
1243 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1244 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1245 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1246 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1247
1248 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1249 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1250 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1251 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001252 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1253 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1254 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1255 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1256 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1257 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1258 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1259 it, so that you don't worry.
1260
1261 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1262 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1263 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1264 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1265 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1266 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1267 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1268 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001269
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001270 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1271 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1272 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1273 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1274 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1275 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1276 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1277 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1278
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001279 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1280 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1281 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1282 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001283 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001284 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1285 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1286 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1287 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1288 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001289 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1290 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1291 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1292 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1293 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1294 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001295
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001296 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1297 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1298 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1299 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1300 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1301 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1302 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1303 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001304 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001305 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001306 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1307 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1308 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001309
1310 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1311 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1312 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1313 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1314 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1315 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1316 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001317 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1318 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1319 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001320
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001321 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1322 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1323 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1324 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1325 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1326 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1327 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1328 URIs start with a leading "/".
1329
1330 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1331 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1332 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1333 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1334
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001335 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001336 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1337
1338 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
1339 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
Willy Tarreau61a21a32011-03-01 20:35:49 +01001340 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1341 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001342 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1343 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1344 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1345 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1346 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1347 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1348 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1349 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1350 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1351 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1352 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1353 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1354 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1355 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1356 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1357 be randomly balanced if at all.
1358
1359 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1360 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1361 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1362 server will receive the request.
1363
1364 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1365 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1366 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1367 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1368 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001369 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1370 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1371 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001372
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001373 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP request.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001374 Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, the header
1375 name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the header is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001376 absent or if it does not contain any value, the roundrobin
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001377 algorithm is applied instead.
1378
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001379 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001380 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1381 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1382 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1383
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001384 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1385 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1386 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1387
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001388 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001389 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001390 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1391 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1392 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1393 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1394 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1395 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001396 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001397 used instead.
1398
1399 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1400 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1401 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1402 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1403
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001404 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1405 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1406 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1407
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001408 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
1409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001410 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001411 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1412 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001413
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001414 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001415 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001416
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001417 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1418 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1419 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001420
1421 Examples :
1422 balance roundrobin
1423 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001424 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001425 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1426 balance hdr(host)
1427 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001428
1429 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1430 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1431
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001432 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001433 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1434 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1435 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1436 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1437
1438 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1439 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1440 defaults to 16 kB.
1441
1442 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1443 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1444
1445 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1446 Round Robin.
1447
1448 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1449 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1450 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1451 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1452
1453 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1454
1455 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001456 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001457 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1458 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1459 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001460
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001461 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1462 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001463
1464
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001465bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1466bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1467bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1468bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1469bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1470bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1471bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001472bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001473bind /<path> [, ...]
1474bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1475bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1476bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001477 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1479 no | yes | yes | no
1480 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001481 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1482 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1483 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1484 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001485 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001486
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001487 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1488 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001489 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1490 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1491 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001492 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1493 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1494 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1495 the range.
1496
1497 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1498 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1499 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1500 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1501 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1502 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1503 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1504 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1505 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001506
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001507 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1508 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1509 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1510 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1511 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1512 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1513 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1514 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1515
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001516 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1517 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1518 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1519 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1520 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1521 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1522 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1523 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001524 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1525 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001526
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001527 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1528 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1529 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1530 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1531 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1532 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
Willy Tarreau48a7e722010-12-24 15:26:39 +01001533 work on other operating systems. It may also not change the
1534 advertised value but change the effective size of outgoing
1535 segments. The commonly advertised value on Ethernet networks
1536 is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is positive,
1537 it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it
1538 will indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's
1539 advertised MSS for outgoing segments. This parameter is only
1540 compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001541
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001542 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1543 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1544 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1545 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001546
1547 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1548
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001549 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1550 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1551 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1552 simply ignore this.
1553
1554 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1555 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1556 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1557 simply ignore this.
1558
1559 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1560 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1561 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1562 this.
1563
1564 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1565 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1566 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1567 this.
1568
1569 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1570 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1571 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1572 this.
1573
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001574 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1575 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1576 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001577 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001578 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1579 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1580 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1581 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001582 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1583 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001584
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001585 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001586 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1587 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1588 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1589 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1590 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1591 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1592 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1593 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1594 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1595 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1596 with front firewalls which would see an established
1597 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1598
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001599 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1600 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1601 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1602 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1603 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1604 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1605 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1606 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1607 This keyword combined with support from external components
1608 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1609 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1610 not even always usable.
1611
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001612 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1613 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1614 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1615 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1616 in a frontend.
1617
1618 Example :
1619 listen http_proxy
1620 bind :80,:443
1621 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001622 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001623
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001624 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001625 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001626
1627
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001628bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1629 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1631 yes | yes | yes | yes
1632 Arguments :
1633 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1634 may be used to override a default value.
1635
1636 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1637 option may be combined with other numbers.
1638
1639 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1640 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1641 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1642 missing from all processes.
1643
1644 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1645 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1646 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1647 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1648
1649 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1650 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1651 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1652 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1653 and 'even' instances.
1654
1655 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1656 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1657 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1658 32.
1659
1660 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1661 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1662
1663 Example :
1664 listen app_ip1
1665 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001666 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001667
1668 listen app_ip2
1669 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001670 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001671
1672 listen management
1673 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001674 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001675
1676 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1677
1678
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001679block { if | unless } <condition>
1680 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1682 no | yes | yes | yes
1683
1684 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1685 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001686 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001687 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001688 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1689 "block" statements per instance.
1690
1691 Example:
1692 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1693 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1694 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1695 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1696
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001697 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001698
1699
1700capture cookie <name> len <length>
1701 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1703 no | yes | yes | no
1704 Arguments :
1705 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1706 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1707 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1708 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1709 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1710
1711 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1712 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1713 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1714 right if it exceeds <length>.
1715
1716 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1717 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1718 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1719 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1720
1721 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1722 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1723 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1724
1725 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1726 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1727 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1728 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001729 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001730 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1731
1732 Example:
1733 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1734
1735 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001736 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001737
1738
1739capture request header <name> len <length>
1740 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1742 no | yes | yes | no
1743 Arguments :
1744 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001745 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001746 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1747 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1748 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1749
1750 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1751 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1752 it exceeds <length>.
1753
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001754 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001755 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1756 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001757 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1758 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1759 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1760 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001761 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001762 environments to find where the request came from.
1763
1764 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1765 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1766 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1767 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001768
1769 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1770 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1771 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1772 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1773
1774 Example:
1775 capture request header Host len 15
1776 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1777 capture request header Referrer len 15
1778
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001779 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001780 about logging.
1781
1782
1783capture response header <name> len <length>
1784 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1786 no | yes | yes | no
1787 Arguments :
1788 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001789 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001790 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1791 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1792 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1793
1794 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1795 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1796 it exceeds <length>.
1797
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001798 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001799 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1800 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1801 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001802 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1803 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1804 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1805 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001806
1807 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1808 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1809 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1810 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1811
1812 Example:
1813 capture response header Content-length len 9
1814 capture response header Location len 15
1815
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001816 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001817 about logging.
1818
1819
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001820clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001821 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1823 yes | yes | yes | no
1824 Arguments :
1825 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1826 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1827 as explained at the top of this document.
1828
1829 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1830 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1831 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1832 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1833 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1834 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1835 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1836 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001837 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001838 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1839 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1840
1841 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1842 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1843 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1844 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1845 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1846 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1847
1848 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1849 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1850
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001851 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1852 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001853
1854
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001855contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001856 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1858 yes | no | yes | yes
1859 Arguments :
1860 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1861 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1862 as explained at the top of this document.
1863
1864 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001865 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001866 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001867 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1868 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1869 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1870 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1871
1872 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1873 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1874 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1875 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1876 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1877 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1878
1879 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1880 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1881 instead.
1882
1883 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1884 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1885
1886
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001887cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001888 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001889 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001890 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1892 yes | no | yes | yes
1893 Arguments :
1894 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1895 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1896 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1897 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1898 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1899 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1900 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1901 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1902 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1903
1904 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1905 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1906 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1907 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1908 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1909 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1910 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1911 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1912 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1913 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1914 "insert" and "prefix".
1915
1916 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001917 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001918
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001919 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001920 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1921 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1922 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1923 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1924 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1925 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1926 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1927 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1928 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1929 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001930
1931 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1932 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1933 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1934 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1935 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1936 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1937 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1938 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1939 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1940 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001941 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1942 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1943 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001944
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001945 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1946 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1947 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001948 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1949 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1950 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1951 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001952 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1953 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1954 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001955
1956 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1957 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1958 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1959 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1960 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1961 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1962 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1963 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1964 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1965
1966 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1967 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1968 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1969 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1970 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1971 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1972 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1973 persistence cookie in the cache.
1974 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1975
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001976 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1977 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1978 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1979 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1980 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1981 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1982 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1983 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1984 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1985 they logout.
1986
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001987 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001988 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001989 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1990 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1991 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1992 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1993 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1994 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001995
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001996 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1997 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1998 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1999 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2000 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2001 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2002 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2003 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2004 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2005 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2006 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2007 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2008 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2009 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2010 the site.
2011
2012 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2013 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2014 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2015 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2016 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2017 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2018 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2019 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2020 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2021 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2022 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2023 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2024 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2025 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2026 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2027 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2028
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002029 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2030 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2031 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2032 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002033
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002034 Examples :
2035 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2036 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2037 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002038 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002039
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002040 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002041 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002042
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002043
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002044default-server [param*]
2045 Change default options for a server in a backend
2046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2047 yes | no | yes | yes
2048 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002049 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2050 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2051 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2052 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002053
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002054 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002055 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2056
2057 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002058
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002059
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002060default_backend <backend>
2061 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2063 yes | yes | yes | no
2064 Arguments :
2065 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2066
2067 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2068 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2069 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2070 will catch all undetermined requests.
2071
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002072 Example :
2073
2074 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2075 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2076 default_backend dynamic
2077
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002078 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2079
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002080
2081disabled
2082 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2084 yes | yes | yes | yes
2085 Arguments : none
2086
2087 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2088 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2089 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2090 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2091 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2092 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2093 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2094
2095 See also : "enabled"
2096
2097
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002098dispatch <address>:<port>
2099 Set a default server address
2100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2101 no | no | yes | yes
2102 Arguments : none
2103
2104 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2105 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2106 during start-up.
2107
2108 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2109 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2110 possible with normal servers.
2111
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002112 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002113 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2114 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2115 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2116 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2117
2118 See also : "server"
2119
2120
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002121enabled
2122 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2124 yes | yes | yes | yes
2125 Arguments : none
2126
2127 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2128 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2129
2130 See also : "disabled"
2131
2132
2133errorfile <code> <file>
2134 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2136 yes | yes | yes | yes
2137 Arguments :
2138 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002139 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002140
2141 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002142 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002143 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002144 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2145 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002146
2147 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2148 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2149 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2150
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002151 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2152
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002153 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2154 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2155 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2156 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2157
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002158 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2159 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2160 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2161 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2162 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2163 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2164
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002165 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2166 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2167 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002168 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002169 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2170
2171 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2172
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002173 Example :
2174 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2175 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2176 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2177
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002178
2179errorloc <code> <url>
2180errorloc302 <code> <url>
2181 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2183 yes | yes | yes | yes
2184 Arguments :
2185 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002186 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002187
2188 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2189 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2190 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2191 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2192 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2193
2194 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2195 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2196 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2197
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002198 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2199
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002200 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2201 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2202 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2203 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2204 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2205 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2206 request.
2207
2208 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2209
2210
2211errorloc303 <code> <url>
2212 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2214 yes | yes | yes | yes
2215 Arguments :
2216 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2217 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2218
2219 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2220 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2221 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2222 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2223 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2224
2225 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2226 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2227 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2228
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002229 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2230
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002231 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2232 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2233 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2234 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002235 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002236
2237 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2238
2239
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002240force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2241 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2242 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2243 no | yes | yes | yes
2244
2245 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2246 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2247 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2248 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2249 marked down for maintenance operations.
2250
2251 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2252 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2253 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2254 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2255 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2256 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2257 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2258 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2259 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2260
2261 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2262 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2263 is used.
2264
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002265 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002266 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002267
2268
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002269fullconn <conns>
2270 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2272 yes | no | yes | yes
2273 Arguments :
2274 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2275 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2276
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002277 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002278 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002279 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002280 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2281 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2282 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2283 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2284 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002285 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002286
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002287 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2288 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2289 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2290
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002291 Example :
2292 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2293 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2294 # connections.
2295 backend dynamic
2296 fullconn 10000
2297 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2298 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2299
2300 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2301
2302
2303grace <time>
2304 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002306 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002307 Arguments :
2308 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2309 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2310 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2311
2312 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2313 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002314 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002315 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2316
2317 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2318 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2319 simplify it.
2320
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002321
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002322hash-type <method>
2323 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2325 yes | no | yes | yes
2326 Arguments :
2327 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2328 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2329 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2330 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2331 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2332 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2333 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2334 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2335 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2336
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002337 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2338 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2339 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2340 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2341 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2342 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2343 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2344 this value.
2345
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002346 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2347 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2348 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2349 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2350 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2351 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2352 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2353 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2354 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2355 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2356 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2357 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2358 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2359
2360 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2361
2362 See also : "balance", "server"
2363
2364
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002365http-check disable-on-404
2366 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002368 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002369 Arguments : none
2370
2371 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2372 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2373 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2374 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2375 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2376 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2377 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2378 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002379 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2380 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2381 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2382
2383 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2384
2385
2386http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2387 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002389 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002390 Arguments :
2391 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2392 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
2393 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
2394 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2395 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2396 details on the supported keywords.
2397
2398 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2399 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2400 with the usual backslash ('\').
2401
2402 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2403 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2404 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2405 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2406 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2407
2408 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2409 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2410 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2411 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2412 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2413
2414 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2415 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2416 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2417 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2418 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2419 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2420
2421 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2422 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2423 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2424 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2425 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2426 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2427 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2428 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2429 trace).
2430
2431 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2432 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2433 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2434 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2435 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2436 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2437 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2438 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2439
2440 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2441 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2442 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2443 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2444 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2445 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2446 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2447 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2448
2449 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2450 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2451
2452 Examples :
2453 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002454 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002455
2456 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002457 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002458
2459 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002460 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002461
2462 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002463 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002464
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002465 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002466
2467
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002468http-check send-state
2469 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2471 yes | no | yes | yes
2472 Arguments : none
2473
2474 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2475 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2476 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2477 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2478 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2479
2480 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2481 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2482 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2483 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2484 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2485 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2486 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2487 checked in multiple backends.
2488
2489 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2490 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2491
2492 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2493 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2494 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2495 one fails.
2496
2497 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2498 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2499 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2500
2501 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2502 server's queue.
2503
2504 Example of a header received by the application server :
2505 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2506 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2507
2508 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2509
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002510http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002511 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002512 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2513
2514 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2515 no | yes | yes | yes
2516
2517 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2518 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2519 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002520 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2521 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002522 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2523
2524 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2525 instance.
2526
2527 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002528 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2529 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2530 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002531
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002532 http-request allow if nagios
2533 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2534 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2535 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002536
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002537 Example:
2538 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002539
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002540 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002541
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002542 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2543 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002544
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002545http-send-name-header [<header>]
2546 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2547
2548 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2549 yes | no | yes | yes
2550
2551 Arguments :
2552
2553 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2554
2555 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2556 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2557 is added with the header string proved.
2558
2559 See also : "server"
2560
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002561id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002562 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2564 no | yes | yes | yes
2565 Arguments : none
2566
2567 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2568 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2569 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002570
2571
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002572ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2573 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2574 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2575 no | yes | yes | yes
2576
2577 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2578 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2579 and running).
2580
2581 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2582 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2583 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2584 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2585 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2586
2587 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2588 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2589
2590 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2591 "unless" condition is met.
2592
2593 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2594
2595
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002596log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002597log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002598no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002599 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2601 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002602
2603 Prefix :
2604 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2605 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2606 prefix does not allow arguments.
2607
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002608 Arguments :
2609 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2610 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2611 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2612 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2613 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2614 parameter.
2615
2616 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2617 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2618
2619 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2620 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2621 standard syslog port).
2622
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002623 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2624 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2625 standard syslog port).
2626
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002627 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2628 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2629 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2630 appropriately writeable).
2631
2632 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2633
2634 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2635 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2636 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2637
2638 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2639 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2640 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002641 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2642 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2643 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2644 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2645 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002646
2647 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2648
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002649 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2650 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2651 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002652
2653 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2654 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2655 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2656 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2657
2658 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2659 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002660
2661 Example :
2662 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002663 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2664 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002665
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002666log-format <string>
2667 Allows you to custom a log line.
2668
2669 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2670
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002671
2672maxconn <conns>
2673 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2675 yes | yes | yes | no
2676 Arguments :
2677 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2678 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2679 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2680 closes.
2681
2682 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2683 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2684 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2685 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2686 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2687 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2688 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2689 properly tuned.
2690
2691 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2692 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2693 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2694
2695 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2696
2697
2698mode { tcp|http|health }
2699 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2701 yes | yes | yes | yes
2702 Arguments :
2703 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2704 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2705 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2706 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2707
2708 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2709 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2710 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2711 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2712 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2713
2714 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2715 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2716 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2717 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2718 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2719 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2720
2721 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2722 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2723 will be refused.
2724
2725 Example :
2726 defaults http_instances
2727 mode http
2728
2729 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
2730
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002731
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002732monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002733 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2735 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002736 Arguments :
2737 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2738 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002739 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002740 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2741 backend and its backup.
2742
2743 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2744 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2745 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2746 servers in a list of backends.
2747
2748 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2749 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2750 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2751 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2752 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2753 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2754 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002755 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2756 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002757
2758 Example:
2759 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002760 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002761 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2762 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2763 monitor-uri /site_alive
2764 monitor fail if site_dead
2765
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002766 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002767
2768
2769monitor-net <source>
2770 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2772 yes | yes | yes | no
2773 Arguments :
2774 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2775 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2776 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2777 followed by a mask.
2778
2779 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2780 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002781 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002782 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2783
2784 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2785 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2786 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2787 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2788 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2789
2790 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2791 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2792 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2793 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2794 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2795
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002796 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2797 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
2798
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002799 Example :
2800 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2801 frontend www
2802 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2803
2804 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2805
2806
2807monitor-uri <uri>
2808 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2810 yes | yes | yes | no
2811 Arguments :
2812 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2813 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2814
2815 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2816 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2817 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2818 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2819 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2820 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2821 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2822 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2823
2824 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2825 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2826 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2827 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2828 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2829 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2830
2831 Example :
2832 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2833 frontend www
2834 mode http
2835 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2836
2837 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2838
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002839
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002840option abortonclose
2841no option abortonclose
2842 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2844 yes | no | yes | yes
2845 Arguments : none
2846
2847 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2848 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2849 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2850 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002851 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002852 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2853 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2854 encountered while delivering the response.
2855
2856 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2857 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2858 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2859 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2860 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2861 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002862 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002863 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002864 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002865 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2866 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2867 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2868
2869 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2870 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2871 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2872 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2873 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2874 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2875 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2876 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002877 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002878
2879 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2880 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2881
2882 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2883
2884
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002885option accept-invalid-http-request
2886no option accept-invalid-http-request
2887 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2889 yes | yes | yes | no
2890 Arguments : none
2891
2892 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2893 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2894 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2895 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2896 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2897 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2898 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2899 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002900 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2901 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2902 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2903 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2904 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2905 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002906
2907 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2908 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2909 been confirmed.
2910
2911 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2912 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002913 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2914 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002915 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2916
2917 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2918 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2919
2920 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2921 stats socket.
2922
2923
2924option accept-invalid-http-response
2925no option accept-invalid-http-response
2926 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2928 yes | no | yes | yes
2929 Arguments : none
2930
2931 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2932 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2933 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2934 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2935 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2936 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2937 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2938 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2939 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2940
2941 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2942 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2943 been confirmed.
2944
2945 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2946 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2947 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2948 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2949
2950 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2951 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2952
2953 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2954 stats socket.
2955
2956
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002957option allbackups
2958no option allbackups
2959 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2961 yes | no | yes | yes
2962 Arguments : none
2963
2964 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2965 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2966 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2967 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2968 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2969 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2970 order between the backup servers anymore.
2971
2972 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2973 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2974
2975 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2976 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2977
2978
2979option checkcache
2980no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002981 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2983 yes | no | yes | yes
2984 Arguments : none
2985
2986 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2987 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002988 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002989 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2990 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002991 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002992
2993 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002994 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002995 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002996 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2997 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002998 to the client are :
2999 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003000 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003001 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003002 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3003 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3004 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3005 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3006 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3007 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3008 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3009 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3010 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3011 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3012 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3013
3014 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003015 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003016 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003017 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003018 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3019
3020 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3021 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003022 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003023 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3024
3025 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3026 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3027
3028
3029option clitcpka
3030no option clitcpka
3031 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3033 yes | yes | yes | no
3034 Arguments : none
3035
3036 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3037 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3038 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3039 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3040
3041 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3042 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3043 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3044 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3045
3046 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3047 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3048 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3049 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3050 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3051
3052 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3053
3054 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3055 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3056 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3057
3058 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3059 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3060
3061 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3062
3063
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003064option contstats
3065 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3067 yes | yes | yes | no
3068 Arguments : none
3069
3070 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3071 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3072 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3073 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3074 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3075 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3076 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3077
3078
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003079option dontlog-normal
3080no option dontlog-normal
3081 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3083 yes | yes | yes | no
3084 Arguments : none
3085
3086 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3087 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3088 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3089 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3090 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3091 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3092 logged.
3093
3094 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3095 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3096 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3097
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003098 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003099 logging.
3100
3101
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003102option dontlognull
3103no option dontlognull
3104 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3106 yes | yes | yes | no
3107 Arguments : none
3108
3109 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3110 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3111 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3112 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3113 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3114 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3115 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3116
3117 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3118 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3119 would not be logged.
3120
3121 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3122 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3123
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003124 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003125
3126
3127option forceclose
3128no option forceclose
3129 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003131 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003132 Arguments : none
3133
3134 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3135 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3136 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3137 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3138 global session times in the logs.
3139
3140 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003141 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003142 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3143 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3144 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3145 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003146
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003147 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3148 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3149 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3150
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003151 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3152 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3153
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003154 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003155
3156
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003157option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003158 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3160 yes | yes | yes | yes
3161 Arguments :
3162 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3163 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003164 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003165 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003166
3167 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3168 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3169 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3170 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3171 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3172 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3173 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003174 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3175 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3176 possible that the client has already brought one.
3177
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003178 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003179 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003180 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3181 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003182 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3183 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003184
3185 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3186 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3187 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3188 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3189 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3190 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3191 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3192
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003193 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3194 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3195 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3196 are under the control of the end-user.
3197
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003198 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003199 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3200 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003201 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3202 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3203 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003204
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003205 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3206 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3207 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3208 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3209 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003210
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003211 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003212 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3213 frontend www
3214 mode http
3215 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3216
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003217 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3218 backend www
3219 mode http
3220 option forwardfor header X-Client
3221
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003222 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3223 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003224
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003225
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003226option http-no-delay
3227no option http-no-delay
3228 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3230 yes | yes | yes | yes
3231 Arguments : none
3232
3233 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3234 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3235 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3236 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3237 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3238 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3239 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3240 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3241 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3242 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3243 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3244 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3245 affected.
3246
3247 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3248 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3249 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3250 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3251 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3252 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3253 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3254 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3255 latency environments.
3256
3257
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003258option http-pretend-keepalive
3259no option http-pretend-keepalive
3260 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3262 yes | yes | yes | yes
3263 Arguments : none
3264
3265 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3266 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3267 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3268 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3269 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3270 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3271 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3272 consider the response complete.
3273
3274 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3275 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3276 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3277 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3278 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3279 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3280
3281 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3282 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3283 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3284 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3285 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3286 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3287 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3288
3289 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3290 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003291 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
3292 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3293 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003294
3295 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3296 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3297
3298 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3299
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003300
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003301option http-server-close
3302no option http-server-close
3303 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3305 yes | yes | yes | yes
3306 Arguments : none
3307
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003308 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3309 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3310 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3311 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3312 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3313 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3314 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3315 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3316 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3317 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3318 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3319 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003320
3321 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3322 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3323 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3324 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003325 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3326 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003327
3328 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3329 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003330 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3331 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3332 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003333
3334 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3335 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3336
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003337 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3338 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003339
3340
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003341option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003342no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003343 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3345 yes | yes | yes | no
3346 Arguments : none
3347
3348 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3349 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3350 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3351 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3352 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3353 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3354 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3355
3356 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3357 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3358 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3359 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3360 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3361 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3362 request along its whole life.
3363
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003364 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3365 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3366 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3367 front of an existing proxy.
3368
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003369 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3370
3371 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3372 http-server-close".
3373
3374
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003375option httpchk
3376option httpchk <uri>
3377option httpchk <method> <uri>
3378option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3379 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3381 yes | no | yes | yes
3382 Arguments :
3383 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3384 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3385 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3386 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3387 ones.
3388
3389 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3390 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3391 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3392
3393 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3394 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3395 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3396 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3397 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3398
3399 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3400 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3401 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3402 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3403 the lack of any response.
3404
3405 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3406
3407 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3408 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3409 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3410
3411 Examples :
3412 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3413 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3414 backend https_relay
3415 mode tcp
3416 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3417 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3418
3419 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003420 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3421 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003422
3423
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003424option httpclose
3425no option httpclose
3426 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3428 yes | yes | yes | yes
3429 Arguments : none
3430
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003431 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3432 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3433 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3434 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3435 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3436 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3437 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003438
3439 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003440 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3441 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3442 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3443 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3444 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3445 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003446
3447 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3448 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3449 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003450 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3451 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003452
3453 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3454 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3455
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003456 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3457 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003458
3459
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003460option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003461 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3463 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003464 Arguments :
3465 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3466 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3467 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3468 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3469 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003470
3471 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3472 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3473 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3474 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3475 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3476 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3477 ports.
3478
3479 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3480
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003481 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3482 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3483 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3484 by default.
3485
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003486 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003487
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003488
3489option http_proxy
3490no option http_proxy
3491 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3493 yes | yes | yes | yes
3494 Arguments : none
3495
3496 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3497 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3498 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3499 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3500 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3501
3502 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3503 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3504 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3505 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003506 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003507 be analyzed.
3508
3509 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3510 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3511
3512 Example :
3513 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3514 backend direct_forward
3515 option httpclose
3516 option http_proxy
3517
3518 See also : "option httpclose"
3519
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003520
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003521option independant-streams
3522no option independant-streams
3523 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3525 yes | yes | yes | yes
3526 Arguments : none
3527
3528 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3529 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3530 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3531 receive data or not.
3532
3533 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3534 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3535 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3536 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3537 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3538 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3539 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3540 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3541 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3542 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3543 socket buffers.
3544
3545 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3546 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3547 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3548 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3549 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3550
3551 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout server"
3552
3553
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003554option ldap-check
3555 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3557 yes | no | yes | yes
3558 Arguments : none
3559
3560 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3561 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3562 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3563 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3564
3565 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3566 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3567
3568 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3569 configure it.
3570
3571 Example :
3572 option ldap-check
3573
3574 See also : "option httpchk"
3575
3576
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003577option log-health-checks
3578no option log-health-checks
3579 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3581 yes | no | yes | yes
3582 Arguments : none
3583
3584 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3585 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3586 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3587 of additional information is limited.
3588
3589 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3590 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3591
3592 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3593
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003594
3595option log-separate-errors
3596no option log-separate-errors
3597 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3599 yes | yes | yes | no
3600 Arguments : none
3601
3602 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3603 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3604 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3605 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3606 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3607 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3608 provides very important information.
3609
3610 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3611 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3612 error logs.
3613
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003614 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003615 logging.
3616
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003617
3618option logasap
3619no option logasap
3620 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3622 yes | yes | yes | no
3623 Arguments : none
3624
3625 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3626 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3627 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3628 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3629 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3630 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3631 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003632 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003633 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3634 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3635
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003636 Examples :
3637 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3638 mode http
3639 option httplog
3640 option logasap
3641 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3642
3643 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3644 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3645 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3646 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3647
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003648 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003649 logging.
3650
3651
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003652option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3653 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3655 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003656 Arguments :
3657 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3658 to MySQL server.
3659
3660 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3661 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3662 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3663 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3664 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3665 in the MySQL table, like this :
3666
3667 USE mysql;
3668 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3669 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3670
3671 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3672 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3673 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3674 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3675 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3676 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3677 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3678 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3679 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3680
3681 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3682 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003683
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003684 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003685
3686 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3687 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3688 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3689 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3690 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3691 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3692
3693 See also: "option httpchk"
3694
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003695option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3696 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3698 yes | no | yes | yes
3699 Arguments :
3700 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3701 to PostgreSQL server.
3702
3703 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3704 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3705 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3706 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3707
3708 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003709
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003710option nolinger
3711no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003712 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003713 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3714 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003715 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003716
3717 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3718 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3719 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3720 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3721 connections.
3722
3723 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3724 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3725 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3726 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3727 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3728 this too.
3729
3730 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3731 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3732 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3733
3734 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3735 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3736 for servers.
3737
3738 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3739 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3740
3741
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003742option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3743 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3745 yes | yes | yes | yes
3746 Arguments :
3747 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3748 matching <network>
3749 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3750 header name.
3751
3752 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3753 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3754 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3755 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3756 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3757 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3758 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3759 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3760 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3761 possible that the client has already brought one.
3762
3763 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3764 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3765 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3766 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3767 header and requires different one.
3768
3769 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3770 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3771 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3772 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3773 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3774 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3775 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3776
3777 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3778 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3779 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3780 both are defined.
3781
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003782 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3783 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3784 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3785 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3786 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003787
3788 Examples :
3789 # Original Destination address
3790 frontend www
3791 mode http
3792 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3793
3794 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3795 backend www
3796 mode http
3797 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3798
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003799 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3800 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003801
3802
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003803option persist
3804no option persist
3805 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3806 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3807 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003808 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003809
3810 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3811 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3812 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3813 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3814 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3815 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3816 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3817 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3818 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3819 redirected to another valid server.
3820
3821 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3822 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3823
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003824 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003825
3826
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003827option redispatch
3828no option redispatch
3829 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3830 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3831 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003832 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003833
3834 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3835 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3836 be able to access the service anymore.
3837
3838 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3839 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3840
3841 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3842 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3843 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003844
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003845 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3846 "redisp" keywords.
3847
3848 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3849 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3850
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003851 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003852
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003853
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003854option redis-check
3855 Use redis health checks for server testing
3856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3857 yes | no | yes | yes
3858 Arguments : none
3859
3860 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3861 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3862 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3863 find the "+PONG" response message.
3864
3865 Example :
3866 option redis-check
3867
3868 See also : "option httpchk"
3869
3870
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003871option smtpchk
3872option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3873 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3875 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003876 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003877 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3878 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3879 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3880
3881 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3882 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3883 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3884
3885 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3886 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3887 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3888 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3889 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3890 dead server.
3891
3892 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3893 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3894 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3895 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3896
3897 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3898 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3899 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3900 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3901 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3902
3903 Example :
3904 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3905
3906 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3907
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003908
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003909option socket-stats
3910no option socket-stats
3911
3912 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3914 yes | yes | yes | no
3915
3916 Arguments : none
3917
3918
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003919option splice-auto
3920no option splice-auto
3921 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3923 yes | yes | yes | yes
3924 Arguments : none
3925
3926 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3927 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3928 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3929 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003930 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003931 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3932 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3933 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3934 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3935
3936 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3937 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3938 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3939 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3940 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3941 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3942 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3943 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3944 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3945 keyword.
3946
3947 Example :
3948 option splice-auto
3949
3950 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3951 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3952
3953 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3954 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3955
3956
3957option splice-request
3958no option splice-request
3959 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3961 yes | yes | yes | yes
3962 Arguments : none
3963
3964 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3965 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3966 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3967 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3968 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3969 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3970
3971 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3972
3973 Example :
3974 option splice-request
3975
3976 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3977 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3978
3979 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3980 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3981
3982
3983option splice-response
3984no option splice-response
3985 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3987 yes | yes | yes | yes
3988 Arguments : none
3989
3990 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3991 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3992 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3993 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3994 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3995 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3996
3997 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3998
3999 Example :
4000 option splice-response
4001
4002 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4003 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4004
4005 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4006 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4007
4008
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004009option srvtcpka
4010no option srvtcpka
4011 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4013 yes | no | yes | yes
4014 Arguments : none
4015
4016 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4017 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4018 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4019 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4020
4021 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4022 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4023 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4024 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4025
4026 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4027 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4028 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4029 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4030 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4031
4032 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4033
4034 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4035 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4036 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4037
4038 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4039 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4040
4041 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4042
4043
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004044option ssl-hello-chk
4045 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4047 yes | no | yes | yes
4048 Arguments : none
4049
4050 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4051 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4052 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4053 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4054 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4055 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4056 hello message.
4057
4058 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4059 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4060 messages, which is appreciable.
4061
4062 See also: "option httpchk"
4063
4064
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004065option tcp-smart-accept
4066no option tcp-smart-accept
4067 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4069 yes | yes | yes | no
4070 Arguments : none
4071
4072 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4073 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4074 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4075 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4076 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4077 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4078
4079 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4080 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4081 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4082 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4083
4084 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4085 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4086 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4087 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4088
4089 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4090 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4091 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4092
4093 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4094 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4095 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4096
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004097 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4098
4099
4100option tcp-smart-connect
4101no option tcp-smart-connect
4102 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4104 yes | no | yes | yes
4105 Arguments : none
4106
4107 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4108 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4109 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4110 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4111 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4112
4113 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4114 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4115 complex.
4116
4117 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4118 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4119 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4120
4121 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4122 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4123
4124 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4125
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004126
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004127option tcpka
4128 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4130 yes | yes | yes | yes
4131 Arguments : none
4132
4133 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4134 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4135 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4136 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4137
4138 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4139 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4140 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4141 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4142
4143 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4144 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4145 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4146 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4147 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4148
4149 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4150
4151 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4152 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4153 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4154 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4155 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4156 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4157 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4158 backends.
4159
4160 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4161
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004162
4163option tcplog
4164 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4166 yes | yes | yes | yes
4167 Arguments : none
4168
4169 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4170 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4171 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4172 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4173 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4174 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4175 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4176 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4177
4178 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004180 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004181
4182
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004183option transparent
4184no option transparent
4185 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004187 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004188 Arguments : none
4189
4190 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4191 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4192 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4193 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4194 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4195 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4196 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4197 appropriate server.
4198
4199 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4200 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4201
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004202 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004203 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004204
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004205
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004206persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004207persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004208 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4210 yes | no | yes | yes
4211 Arguments :
4212 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004213 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4214 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004215
4216 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4217 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4218 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4219 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4220 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4221 forwarded to this server.
4222
4223 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4224 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4225 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004226 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004227 a single "listen" section.
4228
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004229 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4230 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4231 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4232
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004233 Example :
4234 listen tse-farm
4235 bind :3389
4236 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4237 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4238 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4239 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4240 persist rdp-cookie
4241 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
4242 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
4243 balance rdp-cookie
4244 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4245 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4246
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004247 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4248 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004249
4250
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004251rate-limit sessions <rate>
4252 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4254 yes | yes | yes | no
4255 Arguments :
4256 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4257 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4258
4259 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4260 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4261 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4262 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4263 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4264 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4265
4266 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4267 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4268 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4269 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4270
4271 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4272 listen smtp
4273 mode tcp
4274 bind :25
4275 rate-limit sessions 10
4276 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4277
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004278 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4279 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4280 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004281
4282 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4283
4284
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004285redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4286redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004287 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4289 no | yes | yes | yes
4290
4291 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004292 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004293
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004294 Arguments :
4295 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4296 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4297 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4298 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004299 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4300 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4301 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4302 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004303
4304 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4305 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4306 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4307 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4308 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4309 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4310 location with a GET method.
4311
4312 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4313 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4314
4315 - "drop-query"
4316 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4317 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4318 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4319 with a location-type redirect.
4320
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004321 - "append-slash"
4322 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4323 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4324 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4325 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4326
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004327 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4328 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4329 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4330 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4331 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4332 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4333 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4334
4335 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4336 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4337 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4338 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4339 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4340 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4341 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004342
4343 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4344 acl clear dst_port 80
4345 acl secure dst_port 8080
4346 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004347 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004348 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004349 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4350
4351 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004352 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4353 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4354 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004355 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004356
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004357 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4358 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4359 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4360
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004361 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004362
4363
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004364redisp (deprecated)
4365redispatch (deprecated)
4366 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4367 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4368 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004369 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004370
4371 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4372 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4373 be able to access the service anymore.
4374
4375 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4376 redistribute them to a working server.
4377
4378 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4379 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4380 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004381
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004382 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4383 "option redispatch" instead.
4384
4385 See also : "option redispatch"
4386
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004387
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004388reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004389 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4391 no | yes | yes | yes
4392 Arguments :
4393 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4394 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004395 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004396
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004397 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4398 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4399
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004400 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4401 the last header of an HTTP request.
4402
4403 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4404 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4405 responses.
4406
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004407 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4408 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4409 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4410
4411 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4412 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004413
4414
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004415reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4416reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004417 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4419 no | yes | yes | yes
4420 Arguments :
4421 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4422 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4423 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4424 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4425 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4426 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4427 ignores case.
4428
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004429 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4430 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4431
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004432 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4433 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4434 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4435 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004436 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004437
4438 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4439 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4440
4441 Example :
4442 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4443 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4444 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4445
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004446 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4447 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004448
4449
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004450reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4451reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004452 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4454 no | yes | yes | yes
4455 Arguments :
4456 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4457 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4458 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4459 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4460 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4461 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4462
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004463 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4464 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4465
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004466 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4467 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4468 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4469 next servers.
4470
4471 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4472 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4473 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4474
4475 Example :
4476 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4477 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4478 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4479
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004480 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4481 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004482
4483
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004484reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4485reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004486 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4488 no | yes | yes | yes
4489 Arguments :
4490 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4491 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4492 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4493 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4494 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4495 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4496 case.
4497
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004498 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4499 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4500
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004501 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4502 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4503 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4504 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004505 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004506
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004507 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004508 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004509 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004510
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004511 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4512 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4513
4514 Example :
4515 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4516 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4517 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4518
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004519 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4520 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004521
4522
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004523reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4524reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004525 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4527 no | yes | yes | yes
4528 Arguments :
4529 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4530 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4531 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4532 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4533 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4534 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4535 case.
4536
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004537 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4538 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4539
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004540 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4541 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4542 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4543 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4544
4545 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4546 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4547
4548 Example :
4549 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4550 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4551 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4552 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4553
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004554 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4555 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004556
4557
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004558reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4559reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004560 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4562 no | yes | yes | yes
4563 Arguments :
4564 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4565 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4566 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4567 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4568 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4569 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4570
4571 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4572 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4573 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4574 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004575 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004576
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004577 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4578 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4579
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004580 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4581 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4582 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4583
4584 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4585 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4586 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4587 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4588 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4589
4590 Example :
4591 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4592 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4593 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4594 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4595
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004596 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4597 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004598
4599
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004600reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4601reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004602 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4604 no | yes | yes | yes
4605 Arguments :
4606 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4607 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4608 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4609 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4610 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4611 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4612 ignores case.
4613
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004614 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4615 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4616
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004617 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4618 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004619 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4620 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4621 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004622 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4623 not set.
4624
4625 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4626 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4627 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4628 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4629 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4630
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004631 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004632 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4633 # block all others.
4634 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4635 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4636
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004637 # block bad guys
4638 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4639 reqitarpit . if badguys
4640
4641 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4642 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004643
4644
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004645retries <value>
4646 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4647 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4648 yes | no | yes | yes
4649 Arguments :
4650 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4651 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4652 default value is 3.
4653
4654 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4655 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4656 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4657
4658 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4659 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4660
4661 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4662 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4663
4664 See also : "option redispatch"
4665
4666
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004667rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004668 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4670 no | yes | yes | yes
4671 Arguments :
4672 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4673 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004674 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004675
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004676 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4677 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4678
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004679 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4680 the last header of an HTTP response.
4681
4682 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4683 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4684 responses.
4685
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004686 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4687 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004688
4689
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004690rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4691rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004692 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4694 no | yes | yes | yes
4695 Arguments :
4696 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4697 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4698 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4699 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4700 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4701 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4702 ignores case.
4703
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004704 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4705 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4706
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004707 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4708 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004709 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004710 client.
4711
4712 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4713 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4714 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4715
4716 Example :
4717 # remove the Server header from responses
4718 reqidel ^Server:.*
4719
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004720 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4721 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004722
4723
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004724rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4725rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004726 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4728 no | yes | yes | yes
4729 Arguments :
4730 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4731 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4732 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4733 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4734 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4735 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4736 ignores case.
4737
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004738 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4739 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4740
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004741 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4742 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4743 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4744 case-sensitive.
4745
4746 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004747 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4748 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4749 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004750
4751 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4752 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4753
4754 Example :
4755 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4756 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4757
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004758 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4759 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004760
4761
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004762rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4763rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004764 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4766 no | yes | yes | yes
4767 Arguments :
4768 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4769 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4770 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4771 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4772 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4773 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4774 ignores case.
4775
4776 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4777 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4778 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4779 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004780 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004781
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004782 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4783 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4784
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004785 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4786 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4787 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4788
4789 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4790 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4791 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4792 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4793 are not case-sensitive.
4794
4795 Example :
4796 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4797 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4798
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004799 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4800 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004801
4802
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004803server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004804 Declare a server in a backend
4805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4806 no | no | yes | yes
4807 Arguments :
4808 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004809 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-server-name" is
4810 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004811
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004812 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4813 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4814 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4815 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004816 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4817 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4818 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4819 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4820 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4821 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004822
4823 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4824 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4825 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4826 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4827 adding this value to the client's port.
4828
4829 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4830 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004831 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004832
4833 Examples :
4834 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4835 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4836
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004837 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4838 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004839
4840
4841source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004842source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004843source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004844 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4846 yes | no | yes | yes
4847 Arguments :
4848 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4849 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4850 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4851 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4852
4853 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4854 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004855 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4856 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4857 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004858
4859 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4860 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4861 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4862 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4863 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4864 <addr>.
4865
4866 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4867 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4868 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4869 port.
4870
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004871 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4872 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4873 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4874 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4875 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4876 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4877 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4878 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4879 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4880 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4881 HTTP header.
4882
4883 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4884 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4885 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4886 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4887 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4888 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4889 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4890 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4891 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4892 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4893
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004894 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4895 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4896 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4897 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4898 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4899 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4900
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004901 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4902 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4903 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4904 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4905
4906 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4907 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4908 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4909 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4910 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4911 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4912
4913 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4914 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4915 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4916 there are two methods :
4917
4918 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4919 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4920 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4921 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4922 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4923 of the client ranges may be used.
4924
4925 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4926 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4927 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4928 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4929 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4930 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4931 same session.
4932
4933 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4934 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4935 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4936 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4937 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4938 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4939
4940 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4941 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4942 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004943 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004944
4945 Examples :
4946 backend private
4947 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4948 source 192.168.1.200
4949
4950 backend transparent_ssl1
4951 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4952 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4953
4954 backend transparent_ssl2
4955 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4956 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4957 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4958
4959 backend transparent_ssl3
4960 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4961 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4962 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4963
4964 backend transparent_smtp
4965 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4966 # with Tproxy version 4.
4967 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4968
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004969 backend transparent_http
4970 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4971 # proxy.
4972 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4973
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004974 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004975 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4976
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004977
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004978srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4979 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4981 yes | no | yes | yes
4982 Arguments :
4983 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4984 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4985 as explained at the top of this document.
4986
4987 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4988 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4989 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4990 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4991 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4992 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4993 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4994
4995 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4996 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4997 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4998 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4999 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005000 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005001 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005002 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005003
5004 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5005 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5006 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5007 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5008 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5009 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5010
5011 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5012 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5013
5014 See also : "timeout server", "timeout client" and "clitimeout".
5015
5016
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005017stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5018 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5020 no | no | yes | yes
5021
5022 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5023 matched.
5024
5025 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5026 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5027
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005028 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5029 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5030 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5031
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005032 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5033 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5034 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5035 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005036
5037 Example :
5038 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5039 backend stats_localhost
5040 stats enable
5041 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5042
5043 Example :
5044 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5045 backend stats_auth
5046 stats enable
5047 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5048 stats admin if TRUE
5049
5050 Example :
5051 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5052 userlist stats-auth
5053 group admin users admin
5054 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5055 group readonly users haproxy
5056 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5057
5058 backend stats_auth
5059 stats enable
5060 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5061 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5062 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5063 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5064
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005065 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5066 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5067 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005068
5069
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005070stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5071 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5073 yes | no | yes | yes
5074 Arguments :
5075 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5076
5077 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5078
5079 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5080 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5081 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5082 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5083 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5084 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5085
5086 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5087 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5088 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005089 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005090
5091 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5092 report using "stats scope".
5093
5094 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5095 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5096 unobvious parameters.
5097
5098 Example :
5099 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5100 backend public_www
5101 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5102 stats enable
5103 stats hide-version
5104 stats scope .
5105 stats uri /admin?stats
5106 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5107 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5108 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5109
5110 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5111 backend private_monitoring
5112 stats enable
5113 stats uri /admin?stats
5114 stats refresh 5s
5115
5116 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5117
5118
5119stats enable
5120 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5122 yes | no | yes | yes
5123 Arguments : none
5124
5125 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5126 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5127 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5128 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5129 - stats auth : no authentication
5130 - stats scope : no restriction
5131
5132 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5133 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5134 unobvious parameters.
5135
5136 Example :
5137 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5138 backend public_www
5139 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5140 stats enable
5141 stats hide-version
5142 stats scope .
5143 stats uri /admin?stats
5144 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5145 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5146 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5147
5148 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5149 backend private_monitoring
5150 stats enable
5151 stats uri /admin?stats
5152 stats refresh 5s
5153
5154 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5155
5156
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005157stats hide-version
5158 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5160 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005161 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005162
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005163 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5164 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5165 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5166 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5167 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5168 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005169
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005170 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5171 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5172 unobvious parameters.
5173
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005174 Example :
5175 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5176 backend public_www
5177 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005178 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005179 stats hide-version
5180 stats scope .
5181 stats uri /admin?stats
5182 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5183 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5184 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005185
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005186 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5187 backend private_monitoring
5188 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005189 stats uri /admin?stats
5190 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005191
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005192 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005193
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005194
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005195stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5196 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5197 Access control for statistics
5198
5199 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5200 no | no | yes | yes
5201
5202 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5203 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5204 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5205 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5206 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5207 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5208
5209 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5210 instance.
5211
5212 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5213 about ACL usage.
5214
5215
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005216stats realm <realm>
5217 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5219 yes | no | yes | yes
5220 Arguments :
5221 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5222 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5223 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5224
5225 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5226 using a backslash ('\').
5227
5228 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5229 only related to authentication.
5230
5231 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5232 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5233 unobvious parameters.
5234
5235 Example :
5236 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5237 backend public_www
5238 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5239 stats enable
5240 stats hide-version
5241 stats scope .
5242 stats uri /admin?stats
5243 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5244 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5245 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5246
5247 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5248 backend private_monitoring
5249 stats enable
5250 stats uri /admin?stats
5251 stats refresh 5s
5252
5253 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5254
5255
5256stats refresh <delay>
5257 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5259 yes | no | yes | yes
5260 Arguments :
5261 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5262 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5263 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5264 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5265 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5266 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5267
5268 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5269 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5270 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5271 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5272
5273 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5274 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5275 unobvious parameters.
5276
5277 Example :
5278 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5279 backend public_www
5280 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5281 stats enable
5282 stats hide-version
5283 stats scope .
5284 stats uri /admin?stats
5285 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5286 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5287 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5288
5289 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5290 backend private_monitoring
5291 stats enable
5292 stats uri /admin?stats
5293 stats refresh 5s
5294
5295 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5296
5297
5298stats scope { <name> | "." }
5299 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5301 yes | no | yes | yes
5302 Arguments :
5303 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5304 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5305 section in which the statement appears.
5306
5307 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5308 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5309 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5310 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5311 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5312 exists.
5313
5314 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5315 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5316 unobvious parameters.
5317
5318 Example :
5319 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5320 backend public_www
5321 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5322 stats enable
5323 stats hide-version
5324 stats scope .
5325 stats uri /admin?stats
5326 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5327 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5328 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5329
5330 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5331 backend private_monitoring
5332 stats enable
5333 stats uri /admin?stats
5334 stats refresh 5s
5335
5336 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5337
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005338
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005339stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005340 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5342 yes | no | yes | yes
5343
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005344 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005345 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5346
5347 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5348 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5349
5350 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5351 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5352 unobvious parameters.
5353
5354 Example :
5355 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5356 backend private_monitoring
5357 stats enable
5358 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5359 stats uri /admin?stats
5360 stats refresh 5s
5361
5362 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5363 global section.
5364
5365
5366stats show-legends
5367 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5368 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5369 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5370 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5371 - IP (socket, server)
5372 - cookie (backend, server)
5373
5374 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5375 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5376 unobvious parameters.
5377
5378 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5379
5380
5381stats show-node [ <name> ]
5382 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5384 yes | no | yes | yes
5385 Arguments:
5386 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5387 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5388
5389 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5390 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
5391 provided for each customer.
5392
5393 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5394 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5395 unobvious parameters.
5396
5397 Example:
5398 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5399 backend private_monitoring
5400 stats enable
5401 stats show-node Europe-1
5402 stats uri /admin?stats
5403 stats refresh 5s
5404
5405 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5406 section.
5407
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005408
5409stats uri <prefix>
5410 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5412 yes | no | yes | yes
5413 Arguments :
5414 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5415 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5416 query string.
5417
5418 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5419 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5420 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5421 possible to reach it in the application.
5422
5423 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005424 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005425 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5426 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5427 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5428 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5429
5430 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5431 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5432 an address or a port to statistics only.
5433
5434 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5435 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5436 unobvious parameters.
5437
5438 Example :
5439 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5440 backend public_www
5441 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5442 stats enable
5443 stats hide-version
5444 stats scope .
5445 stats uri /admin?stats
5446 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5447 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5448 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5449
5450 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5451 backend private_monitoring
5452 stats enable
5453 stats uri /admin?stats
5454 stats refresh 5s
5455
5456 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5457
5458
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005459stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5460 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005462 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005463
5464 Arguments :
5465 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5466 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5467 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5468 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5469
5470 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5471 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5472 the "stick-table" statement.
5473
5474 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5475 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5476 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5477 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5478 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5479
5480 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5481 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5482 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5483 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5484 transformation rules.
5485
5486 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5487 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5488 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5489 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5490 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5491 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5492 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5493
5494 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5495 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5496 ACL based conditions.
5497
5498 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5499 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5500 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5501 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5502
5503 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5504 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5505 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5506 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5507
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005508 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5509 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5510 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5511
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005512 Example :
5513 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5514 # last 30 minutes
5515 backend pop
5516 mode tcp
5517 balance roundrobin
5518 stick store-request src
5519 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5520 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5521 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5522
5523 backend smtp
5524 mode tcp
5525 balance roundrobin
5526 stick match src table pop
5527 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5528 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5529
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005530 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5531 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005532
5533
5534stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5535 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5537 no | no | yes | yes
5538
5539 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5540 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5541 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5542 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5543
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005544 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5545 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5546 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5547
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005548 Examples :
5549 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005550 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005551
5552 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5553 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5554 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5555
5556
5557 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5558 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5559 backend http
5560 mode http
5561 balance roundrobin
5562 stick on src table https
5563 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5564 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5565 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5566
5567 backend https
5568 mode tcp
5569 balance roundrobin
5570 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5571 stick on src
5572 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5573 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5574
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005575 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005576
5577
5578stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5579 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5581 no | no | yes | yes
5582
5583 Arguments :
5584 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5585 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5586 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5587 server is selected.
5588
5589 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5590 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5591 the "stick-table" statement.
5592
5593 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5594 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5595 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5596 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5597 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5598 address.
5599
5600 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5601 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5602 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5603 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5604 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5605 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5606 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5607 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5608 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5609 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5610
5611 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5612 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5613 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5614 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5615 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5616 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5617 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5618
5619 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5620 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5621 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5622 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5623
5624 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5625 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5626 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5627 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5628 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5629 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5630 another protocol or access method.
5631
5632 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5633 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5634 the request.
5635
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005636 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5637 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5638 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5639
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005640 Example :
5641 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5642 # last 30 minutes
5643 backend pop
5644 mode tcp
5645 balance roundrobin
5646 stick store-request src
5647 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5648 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5649 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5650
5651 backend smtp
5652 mode tcp
5653 balance roundrobin
5654 stick match src table pop
5655 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5656 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5657
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005658 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5659 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005660
5661
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005662stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005663 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5664 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005665 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005667 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005668
5669 Arguments :
5670 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5671 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5672 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5673 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5674
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005675 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5676 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5677 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5678 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5679
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005680 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5681 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5682 instance.
5683
5684 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5685 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5686 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5687 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5688 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5689 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005690 to 32 characters.
5691
5692 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5693 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5694 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5695 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5696 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5697 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005698
5699 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005700 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5701 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005702 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5703 increase.
5704
5705 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005706 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5707 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5708 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005709
5710 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5711 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5712 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5713 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5714 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5715 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5716 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5717 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5718 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5719 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5720 parameter (see below).
5721
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005722 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5723 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5724 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5725 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5726 soft restart.
5727
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005728 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5729
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005730 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5731 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5732 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5733 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5734 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
5735 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
5736 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5737 if not expiration delay is specified.
5738
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005739 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5740 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5741 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5742 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005743 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5744 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5745 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5746 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5747 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5748 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5749 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5750 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5751 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5752 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5753 types and their arguments.
5754
5755 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5756 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5757 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5758 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5759
5760 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5761 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5762 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5763 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5764
5765 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5766 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5767 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5768 they were received.
5769
5770 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5771 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5772 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5773 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5774 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5775
5776 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5777 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5778 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5779 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5780 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5781
5782 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5783 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5784 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5785
5786 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5787 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5788 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5789 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5790 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5791
5792 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5793 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5794 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5795 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5796 the client side.
5797
5798 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5799 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5800 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5801 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5802 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5803 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5804 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5805
5806 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5807 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5808 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5809 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5810 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5811 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5812 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5813
5814 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5815 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5816 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5817 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5818 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5819 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5820
5821 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5822 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5823 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5824 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5825
5826 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5827 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5828 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5829 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5830 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5831 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5832 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5833 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5834 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5835 recommended for better fairness.
5836
5837 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5838 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5839 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5840 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5841
5842 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5843 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5844 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5845 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5846 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5847 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5848 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5849 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5850 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5851 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005852
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005853 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5854 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005855 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5856 reference it.
5857
5858 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5859 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5860 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5861 as an exclusive stickiness.
5862
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005863 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5864 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5865 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5866 something that can be ignored.
5867
5868 Example:
5869 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5870 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5871 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5872 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5873
5874 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005875 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005876
5877
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005878stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5879 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5881 no | no | yes | yes
5882
5883 Arguments :
5884 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5885 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5886 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5887 server is selected.
5888
5889 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5890 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5891 the "stick-table" statement.
5892
5893 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5894 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5895 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5896 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5897
5898 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5899 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5900 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5901 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5902 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5903 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
5904 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
5905 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5906 rules.
5907
5908 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5909 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5910 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5911 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5912 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5913 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5914 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5915
5916 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5917 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5918 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5919 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5920
5921 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5922 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5923 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5924 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5925 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5926 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5927 another protocol or access method.
5928
5929 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5930
5931 Example :
5932 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5933 backend https
5934 mode tcp
5935 balance roundrobin
5936 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
5937 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
5938
5939 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5940 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5941
5942 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5943 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5944 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5945
5946 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5947 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
5948
5949 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5950 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5951 # at offset 44.
5952
5953 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5954 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5955
5956 # Learn on response if server hello.
5957 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
5958
5959 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5960 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5961
5962 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5963 extraction.
5964
5965
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005966tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5967 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5969 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005970 Arguments :
5971 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5972 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5973 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005974
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005975 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005976
5977 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5978 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005979 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5980 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5981 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5982 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5983 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5984 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005985
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005986 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5987 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5988 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5989 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005990
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005991 Three types of actions are supported :
5992 - accept :
5993 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5994 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5995 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005996
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005997 - reject :
5998 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5999 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6000 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6001 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6002 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6003 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6004 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6005 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6006 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6007 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6008 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6009 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006010
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006011 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6012 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6013 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6014 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6015 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6016 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6017 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6018 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6019 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006020
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006021 These actions take one or two arguments :
6022 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6023 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6024 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006025
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006026 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6027 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6028 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6029 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006030
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006031 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6032 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6033 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6034 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6035 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6036 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6037 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6038 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6039 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6040 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006041
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006042 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6043 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6044 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006045
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006046 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6047 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6048 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006049
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006050 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006051 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006052 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006053
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006054 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6055 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6056 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006057
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006058 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6059 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6060 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006061
6062 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6063
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006064 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006065
6066
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006067tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6068 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006070 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006071 Arguments :
6072 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6073 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6074 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006075
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006076 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006077
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006078 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6079 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6080 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6081 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6082 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006083
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006084 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6085 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6086 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6087 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6088 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6089 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6090 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6091 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6092 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006093
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006094 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6095 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6096 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6097 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006098
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006099 Three types of actions are supported :
6100 - accept :
6101 - reject :
6102 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006103
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006104 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6105 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006106
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006107 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6108 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6109 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6110 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6111 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6112 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006113
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006114 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006115 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6116 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006117
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006118 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
6119 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full request has been
6120 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6121 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6122 period.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006123
6124 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006125 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6126 # and reject everything else.
6127 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6128 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6129 tcp-request content accept if HTTP is_host_com
6130 tcp-request content reject
6131
6132 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006133 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6134 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6135 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006136 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006137
6138 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6139 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6140 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006141 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006142 tcp-request content reject
6143
6144 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6145 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6146
6147 frontend http
6148 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6149 # protecting all our sites
6150 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6151 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6152 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6153 ...
6154 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6155
6156 backend http_dynamic
6157 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6158 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6159 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6160 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6161 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6162 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6163 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006165 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006166
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006167 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006168
6169
6170tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6171 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006173 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006174 Arguments :
6175 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6176 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6177 as explained at the top of this document.
6178
6179 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6180 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6181 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6182 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6183 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6184
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006185 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6186 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6187 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6188 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6189
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006190 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6191 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006192 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006193 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006194 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6195 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6196 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6197 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006198
6199 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6200 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6201 it pass through unaffected.
6202
6203 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6204 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6205 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006206 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006207 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6208 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006209 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6210 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6211 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006212
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006213 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006214 "timeout client".
6215
6216
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006217tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6218 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6220 no | no | yes | yes
6221 Arguments :
6222 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6223 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6224 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6225
6226 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6227
6228 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6229 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6230 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6231 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
6232 set and expires with no matching rule.
6233
6234 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6235
6236 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6237 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6238 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6239 inserted.
6240
6241 Two types of actions are supported :
6242 - accept :
6243 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6244 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6245 the rules evaluation.
6246
6247 - reject :
6248 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6249 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6250 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediatly closed.
6251
6252 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6253 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6254 for changing the default action to a reject.
6255
6256 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-reponse content"
6257 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has been
6258 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6259 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6260 period.
6261
6262 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6263
6264 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6265
6266
6267tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6268 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6270 no | no | yes | yes
6271 Arguments :
6272 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6273 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6274 as explained at the top of this document.
6275
6276 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6277
6278
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006279timeout check <timeout>
6280 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6281 established.
6282
6283 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6284 yes | no | yes | yes
6285 Arguments:
6286 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6287 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6288 as explained at the top of this document.
6289
6290 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6291 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6292 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6293 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006294 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6295 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6296 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006297
6298 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6299 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6300
6301 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6302 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006303 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006304
6305 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6306 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6307 forget about it.
6308
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006309 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6310 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006311
6312
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006313timeout client <timeout>
6314timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6315 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6317 yes | yes | yes | no
6318 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006319 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006320 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6321 as explained at the top of this document.
6322
6323 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6324 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6325 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6326 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6327 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6328 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6329 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6330 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006331 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006332 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
6333 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
6334
6335 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6336 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6337 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6338 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6339 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6340 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6341
6342 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6343 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6344 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6345
6346 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server".
6347
6348
6349timeout connect <timeout>
6350timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6351 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6353 yes | no | yes | yes
6354 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006355 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006356 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6357 as explained at the top of this document.
6358
6359 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006360 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006361 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006362 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006363 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6364 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006365
6366 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6367 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6368 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6369 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6370 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6371 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6372
6373 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6374 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6375 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6376
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006377 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6378 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006379
6380
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006381timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6382 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6384 yes | yes | yes | yes
6385 Arguments :
6386 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6387 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6388 as explained at the top of this document.
6389
6390 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6391 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6392 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6393 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6394 once the request has started to present itself.
6395
6396 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6397 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6398 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6399 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6400 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6401
6402 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6403 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6404 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6405 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6406
6407 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6408 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6409 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6410 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6411 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006412 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006413
6414 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6415 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6416 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6417 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6418
6419 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6420
6421
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006422timeout http-request <timeout>
6423 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006425 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006426 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006427 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006428 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6429 as explained at the top of this document.
6430
6431 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6432 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6433 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6434 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6435 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6436 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6437 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6438 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6439
6440 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6441 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006442 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6443 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006444
6445 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6446 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6447 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6448 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6449 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6450
6451 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006452 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6453 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6454 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006455
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006456 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006457
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006458
6459timeout queue <timeout>
6460 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6462 yes | no | yes | yes
6463 Arguments :
6464 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6465 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6466 as explained at the top of this document.
6467
6468 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6469 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6470 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6471 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6472 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6473
6474 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6475 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6476 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6477 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6478
6479 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6480
6481
6482timeout server <timeout>
6483timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6484 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6486 yes | no | yes | yes
6487 Arguments :
6488 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6489 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6490 as explained at the top of this document.
6491
6492 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6493 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6494 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6495 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6496 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6497 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6498 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6499
6500 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6501 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6502 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6503 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6504 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006505 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006506 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006507 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006508
6509 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6510 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6511 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6512 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6513 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6514 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6515
6516 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6517 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6518 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6519
6520 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client".
6521
6522
6523timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006524 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6526 yes | yes | yes | yes
6527 Arguments :
6528 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6529 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6530 as explained at the top of this document.
6531
6532 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6533 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6534 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6535
6536 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6537 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6538 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6539 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006540 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006541
6542 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6543
6544
6545transparent (deprecated)
6546 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006548 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006549 Arguments : none
6550
6551 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6552 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6553 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6554 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6555 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6556 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6557 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6558 appropriate server.
6559
6560 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6561
6562 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6563 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6564
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006565 See also: "option transparent"
6566
6567
6568use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6569use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006570 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6572 no | yes | yes | no
6573 Arguments :
6574 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006576 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006577
6578 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6579 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6580 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006581 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6582 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6583 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6584 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006585
6586 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6587 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6588 assign the backend.
6589
6590 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6591 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6592 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6593 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6594 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6595 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6596
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006597 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006598 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006599 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6600 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6601 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6602
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006603 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006604
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006605
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006606use-server <server> if <condition>
6607use-server <server> unless <condition>
6608 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6610 no | no | yes | yes
6611 Arguments :
6612 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
6613
6614 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6615
6616 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6617 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6618 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6619
6620 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6621 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6622 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6623 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6624 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6625 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6626 matches will assign the server.
6627
6628 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6629 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6630 with the next rules until one matches.
6631
6632 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6633 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6634 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6635 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6636
6637 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6638 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6639 stripped.
6640
6641 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6642 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6643 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6644 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6645
6646 Example :
6647 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6648 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6649 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6650 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6651 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6652 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6653 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6654 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6655 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6656
6657 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6658
6659
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010066605. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006661------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006662
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006663The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6664which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6665arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6666settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6667after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6668Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6669address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006671 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006672 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006674The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006676addr <ipv4>
6677 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6678 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6679 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6680 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6681 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006682
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006683 Supported in default-server: No
6684
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006685backup
6686 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6687 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6688 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6689 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6690 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6691 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006692
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006693 Supported in default-server: No
6694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006695check
6696 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01006697 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
6698 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
6699 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
6700 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
6701 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
6702 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
6703 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
6704 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
6705 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
6706 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006708 Supported in default-server: No
6709
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006710cookie <value>
6711 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6712 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6713 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6714 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6715 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6716 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6717 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6718
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006719 Supported in default-server: No
6720
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006721disabled
6722 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6723 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6724 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6725 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6726 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6727
6728 Supported in default-server: No
6729
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006730error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006731 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6732 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6733 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006735 Supported in default-server: Yes
6736
6737 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006738
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006739fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006740 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6741 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6742 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6743
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006744 Supported in default-server: Yes
6745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006746id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006747 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6748 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6749 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006750
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006751 Supported in default-server: No
6752
6753inter <delay>
6754fastinter <delay>
6755downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006756 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6757 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6758 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6759 between checks depending on the server state :
6760
6761 Server state | Interval used
6762 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6763 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6764 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6765 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6766 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6767 or yet unchecked. |
6768 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6769 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6770 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006771
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006772 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6773 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6774 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6775 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6776 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6777 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6778 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6779 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6780 servers.
6781
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006782 Supported in default-server: Yes
6783
6784maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006785 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6786 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6787 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6788 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6789 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6790 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6791 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6792 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006794 Supported in default-server: Yes
6795
6796maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006797 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6798 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6799 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6800 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6801 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6802 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6803 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6804
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006805 Supported in default-server: Yes
6806
6807minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006808 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6809 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6810 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6811 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6812 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6813 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006814 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006815 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006817 Supported in default-server: Yes
6818
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09006819non-stick
6820 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
6821 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
6822 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
6823
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006824observe <mode>
6825 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6826 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6827 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6828 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6829 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6830 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01006831 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006832
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006833 Supported in default-server: No
6834
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006835 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6836
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006837on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006838 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6839 Currently, four modes are available:
6840 - fastinter: force fastinter
6841 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6842 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6843 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6844 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6845
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006846 Supported in default-server: Yes
6847
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006848 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6849
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09006850on-marked-down <action>
6851 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
6852 Currently one action is available:
6853 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions
6854
6855 Actions are disabled by default
6856
6857 Supported in default-server: Yes
6858
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006859port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006860 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6861 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6862 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6863 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6864 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6865 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006867 Supported in default-server: Yes
6868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006869redir <prefix>
6870 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6871 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6872 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6873 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6874 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6875 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6876 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6877 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006878 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006879 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6880 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6881 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6882 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6883 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6884
6885 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6886
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006887 Supported in default-server: No
6888
6889rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006890 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6891 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6892 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6893
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006894 Supported in default-server: Yes
6895
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01006896send-proxy
6897 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
6898 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
6899 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
6900 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
6901 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
6902 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
6903 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
6904 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
6905 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
6906 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
6907 option of the "bind" keyword.
6908
6909 Supported in default-server: No
6910
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006911slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006912 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
6913 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
6914 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
6915 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
6916 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
6917 parameters :
6918
6919 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
6920 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
6921
6922 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
6923 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
6924 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
6925 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
6926
6927 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
6928 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
6929 seen as failed.
6930
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006931 Supported in default-server: Yes
6932
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006933source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006934source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006935source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006936 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
6937 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
6938 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
6939 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
6940
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006941 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
6942 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
6943 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
6944 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
6945 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
6946 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
6947 server.
6948
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006949 Supported in default-server: No
6950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006951track [<proxy>/]<server>
6952 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
6953 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
6954 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
6955 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
6956 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
6957
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006958 Supported in default-server: No
6959
6960weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006961 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
6962 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
6963 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02006964 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
6965 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
6966 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
6967 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
6968 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
6969 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006970
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006971 Supported in default-server: Yes
6972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006973
69746. HTTP header manipulation
6975---------------------------
6976
6977In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
6978response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
6979request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
6980which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
6981against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
6982to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
6983passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
6984headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
6985never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
6986
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006987There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
6988(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
6989rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
6990messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
6991in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006992happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006993add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
6994normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
6995
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006996This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
6997in section 4.2 :
6998
6999 - reqadd <string>
7000 - reqallow <search>
7001 - reqiallow <search>
7002 - reqdel <search>
7003 - reqidel <search>
7004 - reqdeny <search>
7005 - reqideny <search>
7006 - reqpass <search>
7007 - reqipass <search>
7008 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7009 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7010 - reqtarpit <search>
7011 - reqitarpit <search>
7012 - rspadd <string>
7013 - rspdel <search>
7014 - rspidel <search>
7015 - rspdeny <search>
7016 - rspideny <search>
7017 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7018 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7019
7020With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7021is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7022parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7023prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7024Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7025
7026 \t for a tab
7027 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7028 \n for a new line (LF)
7029 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7030 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7031 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7032 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7033 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7034
7035The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7036portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7037above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7038regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
70399 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7040is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7041
7042The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7043after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7044
7045Notes related to these keywords :
7046---------------------------------
7047 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7048 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7049 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7050
7051 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7052 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7053 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7054
7055 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7056 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7057 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7058 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7059 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7060
7061 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7062 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7063 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7064 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7065 useless headers before adding new ones.
7066
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007067 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007068 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7069
7070 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7071 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7072 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7073
7074 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7075 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007076 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007077
7078
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010070797. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7080------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007081
7082The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7083content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7084from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7085simple :
7086
7087 - define test criteria with sets of values
7088 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7089
7090The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7091
7092In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7093
7094 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7095
7096This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7097Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7098and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7099an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7100of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7101
7102ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7103'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7104which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7105
7106There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7107performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7108
7109The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7110
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007111 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7112 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007113 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7114
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007115The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7116specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7117possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007118multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7119be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7120needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7121space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7122match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7123lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7124duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
7125to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
7126instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007127
7128 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7129
7130In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7131the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7132case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7133too.
7134
7135Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7136a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7137ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7138
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007139Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007140
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007141 - integers or integer ranges
7142 - strings
7143 - regular expressions
7144 - IP addresses and networks
7145
7146
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071477.1. Matching integers
7148----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007149
7150Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7151that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7152expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7153may be omitted.
7154
7155For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7156unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7157representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7158
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007159As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7160two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7161instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7162ranges and operators.
7163
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007164For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007165operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7166Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7167of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007168
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007169Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007170
7171 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7172 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7173 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7174 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7175 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7176
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007177For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007178
7179 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7180
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007181This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7182
7183 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7184
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007185
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071867.2. Matching strings
7187---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007188
7189String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7190exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7191characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7192string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7193to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007194before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007195
7196
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071977.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7198-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007199
7200Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7201they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7202possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7203passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7204the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007205the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7206match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007207
7208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072097.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
7210----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007211
7212IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7213netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7214within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007215host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007216difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7217at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7218does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7219parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007220
7221
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072227.5. Available matching criteria
7223--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007224
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072257.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7226------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007227
7228A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7229analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
7230addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
7231
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007232always_false
7233 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7234 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7235
7236always_true
7237 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7238 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7239
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007240avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007241avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007242 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7243 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7244 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7245 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7246 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7247 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7248 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7249 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7250 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7251 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7252 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007253
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007254be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007255be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007256 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7257 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7258 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7259 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7260 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007261
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007262be_id <integer>
7263 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7264 backend it was called.
7265
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007266be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007267be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007268 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7269 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7270 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7271 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7272 sucking of an online dictionary).
7273
7274 Example :
7275 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7276 backend dynamic
7277 mode http
7278 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7279 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007280
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007281connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007282connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007283 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007284 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007285 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7286
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007287 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7288 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007289
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007290 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007291 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7292 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7293 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7294 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7295 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007296 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007297
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007298 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7299 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7300 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7301 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007302
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007303dst <ip_address>
7304 Applies to the local IPv4 address the client connected to. It can be used to
7305 switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007306
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007307dst_conn <integer>
7308 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7309 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7310 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7311 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7312 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7313 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7314
7315dst_port <integer>
7316 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7317 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7318
7319fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007320fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007321 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7322 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7323 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7324 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7325 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7326 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7327 criteria.
7328
7329fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007330 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007331 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007332
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007333fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007334fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007335 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7336 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7337 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7338 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7339 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7340 the rate to go down below the limit.
7341
7342 Example :
7343 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7344 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7345 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7346 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7347 frontend mail
7348 bind :25
7349 mode tcp
7350 maxconn 100
7351 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7352 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7353 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7354 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007355
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007356nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007357nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007358 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7359 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7360 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7361 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7362 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007363
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007364queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007365queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007366 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7367 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7368 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7369 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7370 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7371 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7372 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7373
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007374sc1_bytes_in_rate
7375sc2_bytes_in_rate
7376 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7377 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7378 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7379
7380sc1_bytes_out_rate
7381sc2_bytes_out_rate
7382 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7383 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7384 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7385
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007386sc1_clr_gpc0
7387sc2_clr_gpc0
7388 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7389 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7390 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7391 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7392 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
7393 was verified :
7394
7395 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7396 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7397 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7398 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7399 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
7400 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7401 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7402
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007403sc1_conn_cnt
7404sc2_conn_cnt
7405 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7406 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7407
7408sc1_conn_cur
7409sc2_conn_cur
7410 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7411 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7412 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7413
7414sc1_conn_rate
7415sc2_conn_rate
7416 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7417 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7418 See also src_conn_rate.
7419
7420sc1_get_gpc0
7421sc2_get_gpc0
7422 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7423 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7424
7425sc1_http_err_cnt
7426sc2_http_err_cnt
7427 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7428 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7429 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7430
7431sc1_http_err_rate
7432sc2_http_err_rate
7433 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7434 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7435 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7436 src_http_err_rate.
7437
7438sc1_http_req_cnt
7439sc2_http_req_cnt
7440 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7441 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7442 src_http_req_cnt.
7443
7444sc1_http_req_rate
7445sc2_http_req_rate
7446 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7447 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7448 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7449 src_http_req_rate.
7450
7451sc1_inc_gpc0
7452sc2_inc_gpc0
7453 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7454 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7455 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7456 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7457 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7458 when a first ACL was verified :
7459
7460 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7461 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7462 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7463
7464sc1_kbytes_in
7465sc2_kbytes_in
7466 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7467 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7468 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7469 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7470
7471sc1_kbytes_out
7472sc2_kbytes_out
7473 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7474 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7475 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7476 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7477
7478sc1_sess_cnt
7479sc2_sess_cnt
7480 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7481 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7482 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7483 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
7484 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
7485 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7486
7487sc1_sess_rate
7488sc2_sess_rate
7489 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7490 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7491 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7492 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7493 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
7494 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
7495
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007496so_id <integer>
7497 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7498
7499src <ip_address>
7500 Applies to the client's IPv4 address. It is usually used to limit access to
7501 certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level source
7502 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
7503
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007504src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007505src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007506 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7507 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7508 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007509 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007510
7511src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007512src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007513 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7514 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7515 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007516 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007517
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007518src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
7519src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
7520 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7521 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7522 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
7523 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
7524 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
7525 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7526
7527 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7528 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7529 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7530 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7531 acl save src_clr_gpc0
7532 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7533 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7534
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007535src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007536src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007537 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7538 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7539 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007540 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007541
7542src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007543src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007544 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7545 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7546 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007547 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007548
7549src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007550src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007551 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7552 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7553 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007554 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007555
7556src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007557src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007558 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7559 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7560 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007561 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007562
7563src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007564src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007565 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7566 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7567 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007568 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007569
7570src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007571src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007572 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7573 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7574 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7575 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007576 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007577
7578src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007579src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007580 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7581 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7582 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007583 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007584
7585src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007586src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007587 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7588 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7589 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7590 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007591 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007592
7593src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007594src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007595 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7596 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7597 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7598 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7599 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7600 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7601
7602 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7603 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007604 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007605
7606src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007607src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007608 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7609 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7610 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7611 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007612 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007613
7614src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007615src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007616 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7617 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7618 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7619 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007620 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007621
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007622src_port <integer>
7623 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007624
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007625src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007626src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007627 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7628 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7629 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7630 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007631 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007632
7633src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007634src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007635 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7636 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7637 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7638 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007639 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007640
7641src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007642src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007643 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007644 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7645 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007646 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7647 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7648 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007649 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007650
7651 Example :
7652 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7653 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7654 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7655 listen ssh
7656 bind :22
7657 mode tcp
7658 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007659 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007660 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7661 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7662
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007663srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02007664 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
7665 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
7666 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
7667 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
7668
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007669srv_id <integer>
7670 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7671
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007672srv_is_up(<server>)
7673srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7674 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7675 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7676 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7677 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7678 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7679 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7680 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7681 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7682
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007683table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007684table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007685 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
7686 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
7687
7688table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007689table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007690 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
7691 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
7692 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
7693
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007694
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020076957.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7696---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007697
7698A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7699during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007700through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7701keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007702
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007703rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7704 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7705 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7706 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
7707 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7708
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007709req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007710 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007711 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7712 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7713 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7714 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7715 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7716 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7717
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007718req_proto_http
7719 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7720 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007721 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007722 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7723 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7724
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007725req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007726req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007727 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7728 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7729 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7730 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7731 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7732 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7733 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7734 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7735
7736req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007737req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007738 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7739 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7740 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7741 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7742 cookies.
7743
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007744req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7745 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7746 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7747 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
7748 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7749
7750req_ssl_sni <string>
7751 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7752 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
7753 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
7754 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
7755 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
7756 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
7757 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
7758 hello (type 1), like in the example below.
7759
7760 Examples :
7761 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
7762 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7763 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
7764 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
7765 default_backend bk_sorry_page
7766
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007767req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7768 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7769 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7770 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7771 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7772 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7773 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7774 with TCP request content inspection.
7775
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007776wait_end
7777 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7778 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7779 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7780 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7781 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7782 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7783 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7784 inspection.
7785
7786 Examples :
7787 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7788 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7789 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7790
7791 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7792 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7793 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7794 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7795 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7796 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7797 tcp-request content reject
7798
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007799
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078007.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7801--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007802
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007803A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007804application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7805read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7806than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7807
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02007808cook(<name>) <string>
7809 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
7810 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
7811 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
7812 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
7813 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
7814 sent by the server.
7815
7816 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
7817 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
7818 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
7819
7820 cook(profile) silver gold
7821
7822cook_beg(<name>) <string>
7823 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
7824 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
7825 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7826
7827cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
7828 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
7829 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
7830 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
7831 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
7832 server.
7833
7834cook_dir(<name>) <string>
7835 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
7836 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7837 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
7838 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
7839 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7840
7841cook_dom(<name>) <string>
7842 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
7843 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
7844 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
7845 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7846
7847cook_end(<name>) <string>
7848 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
7849 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
7850 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7851
7852cook_len(<name>) <integer>
7853 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
7854 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
7855 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
7856 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
7857 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7858
7859cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
7860 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
7861 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
7862 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
7863 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
7864 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7865
7866cook_sub(<name>) <string>
7867 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
7868 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
7869 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7870
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007871hdr <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007872hdr(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007873 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
7874 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
7875 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
7876 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
7877 Use the shdr() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7878
7879 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
7880 match any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For
7881 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
7882
7883 hdr(Connection) -i close
7884
7885hdr_beg <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007886hdr_beg(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007887 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
7888 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
7889 response headers sent by the server.
7890
7891hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007892hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007893 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
7894 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
7895 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
7896 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
7897 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
7898 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
7899 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7900
7901hdr_dir <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007902hdr_dir(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007903 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7904 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7905 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
7906 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
7907 headers sent by the server.
7908
7909hdr_dom <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007910hdr_dom(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007911 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7912 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
7913 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
7914 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
7915 server.
7916
7917hdr_end <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007918hdr_end(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007919 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
7920 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
7921 response headers sent by the server.
7922
7923hdr_ip <ip_address>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007924hdr_ip(<header>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007925 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IP address matching
7926 <ip_address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For or
7927 X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7928 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7929
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02007930hdr_len <integer>
7931hdr_len(<header>) <integer>
7932 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
7933 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
7934 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7935 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7936
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007937hdr_reg <regex>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007938hdr_reg(<header>) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02007939 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007940 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
7941 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
7942 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
7943 response headers sent by the server.
7944
7945hdr_sub <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007946hdr_sub(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007947 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
7948 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
7949 response headers sent by the server.
7950
7951hdr_val <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007952hdr_val(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007953 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
7954 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
7955 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
7956 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7957
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007958http_auth(<userlist>)
7959http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007960 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
7961 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
7962 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
7963 of specified groups.
7964
7965 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
7966
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02007967http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02007968 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
7969 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
7970 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
7971 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
7972
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007973method <string>
7974 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
7975 already check for most common methods.
7976
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007977path <string>
7978 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
7979 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
7980 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
7981
7982path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007983 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
7984 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007985
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007986path_dir <string>
7987 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7988 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7989 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7990 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
7991
7992path_dom <string>
7993 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7994 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
7995 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
7996
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007997path_end <string>
7998 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
7999 control file name extension.
8000
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008001path_len <integer>
8002 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8003 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8004
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008005path_reg <regex>
8006 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8007 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8008 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8009
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008010path_sub <string>
8011 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8012 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8013 "path_dir".
8014
8015req_ver <string>
8016 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8017 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8018
8019status <integer>
8020 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8021 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8022 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8023
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008024url <string>
8025 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
8026 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
8027
8028url_beg <string>
8029 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
8030 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
8031
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008032url_dir <string>
8033 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8034 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8035 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8036 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8037
8038url_dom <string>
8039 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8040 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8041 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8042
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008043url_end <string>
8044 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
8045 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008046
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008047url_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008048 Applies to the IP address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request.
8049 It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local network.
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008050 It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008051
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008052url_len <integer>
8053 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
8054 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8055
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008056url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008057 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
8058 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008059 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008060 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008061
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008062url_reg <regex>
8063 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8064 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8065 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008066
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008067url_sub <string>
8068 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8069 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008070
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008071
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080727.6. Pre-defined ACLs
8073---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008074
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008075Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
8076every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008077order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008078
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008079ACL name Equivalent to Usage
8080---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008081FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008082HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008083HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
8084HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008085HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
8086HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
8087HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
8088HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
8089LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008090METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
8091METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
8092METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
8093METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
8094METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
8095METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008096RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008097REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008098TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008099WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
8100---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008101
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008102
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081037.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
8104----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008106Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8107combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008108
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008109 - AND (implicit)
8110 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8111 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008112
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008113A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008115 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008116
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008117Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8118indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008119
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008120For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8121"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8122requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8123is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008125 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8126 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8127 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8128 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008130To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8131and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008132
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008133 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8134 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8135 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8136 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008137
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008138 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8139 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8140 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8141 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008142
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008143It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8144expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8145be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
8146the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
8147
8148 The following rule :
8149
8150 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8151 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8152
8153 Can also be written that way :
8154
8155 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8156
8157It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8158to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8159simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8160sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8161good use is the following :
8162
8163 With named ACLs :
8164
8165 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8166 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8167 monitor fail if site_dead
8168
8169 With anonymous ACLs :
8170
8171 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008173See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008174
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01008175
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010081767.8. Pattern extraction
8177-----------------------
8178
8179The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
8180response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
8181for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
8182
8183All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
8184"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
8185begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
8186arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
8187much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
8188equivalent used in ACLs.
8189
8190The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
8191
8192 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008193 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8194 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8195 according to RFC 4291.
8196
8197 src6 This is the source IPv6 address of the client of the session.
8198 It is of type IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008199
8200 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
8201 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8202 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008203 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8204 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8205 according to RFC 4291.
8206
8207 dst6 This is the destination IPv6 address of the session on the
8208 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8209 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008210 type IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008211
8212 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
8213 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
8214 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
8215 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
8216 type integer and only works with such tables.
8217
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01008218 hdr(<name>) This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
8219 request. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
8220 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02008221
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008222 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008223 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
8224 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
8225 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
8226 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008227
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008228 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008229 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
8230 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
8231 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
8232 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
8233 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
8234 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
8235 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
8236 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
8237
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008238 url_param(<name>)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008239 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008240 the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008241 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url (e.g.
8242 http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
8243 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
8244
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008245 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008246 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
8247 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
8248 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
8249 done if there is no msts cookie present.
8250
8251 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
8252 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
8253 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
8254 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
8255 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
8256 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
8257 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
8258
8259 Example :
8260 listen tse-farm
8261 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
8262 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8263 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8264 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8265 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8266 persist rdp-cookie
8267 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
8268 # This is only useful makes sense if
8269 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
8270 stick-table type string size 204800
8271 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
8272 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8273 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
8274
8275 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
8276 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
8277
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008278 cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008279 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8280 "Cookie" header line from the request and uses the corresponding
8281 value to match. A typical use is to get multiple clients sharing
8282 a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
8283 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with
8284 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across
8285 restarts.
8286
8287 See also : "appsession"
8288
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008289 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008290 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8291 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
8292 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
8293 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
8294 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
8295
8296 See also : "appsession"
8297
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008298
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008299The currently available list of transformations include :
8300
8301 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
8302 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8303 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8304
8305 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
8306 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8307 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8308
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008309 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01008310 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
8311 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8312 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8313 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8314
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083168. Logging
8317----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008318
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008319One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
8320provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
8321very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
8322provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
8323state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008324to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008325headers.
8326
8327In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
8328about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
8329send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
8330
8331 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
8332 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
8333 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
8334 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
8335 at the termination.
8336
8337The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
8338allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
8339as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
8340while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
8341real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
8342delay.
8343
8344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083458.1. Log levels
8346---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008347
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008348TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008349source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008350HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
8351in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
8352track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
8353syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
8354about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008355
8356
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083578.2. Log formats
8358----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008359
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008360HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008361and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
8362slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
8363options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008364
8365 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
8366 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
8367 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
8368 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
8369 extents.
8370
8371 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
8372 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
8373 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
8374 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
8375 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
8376
8377 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
8378 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
8379 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
8380 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
8381 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
8382
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008383 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
8384 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
8385 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
8386 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
8387
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008388 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
8389
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008390Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
8391specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
8392field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
8393servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
8394always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
8395identifier.
8396
8397Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
8398 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
8399 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
8400 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
8401 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
8402
8403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084048.2.1. Default log format
8405-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008406
8407This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
8408as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
8409format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
8410
8411 Example :
8412 listen www
8413 mode http
8414 log global
8415 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8416
8417 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
8418 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
8419 (www/HTTP)
8420
8421 Field Format Extract from the example above
8422 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
8423 2 'Connect from' Connect from
8424 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
8425 4 'to' to
8426 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
8427 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
8428
8429Detailed fields description :
8430 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
8431 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
8432 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
8433 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
8434 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8435 and processed the connection.
8436 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
8437
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008438In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
8439"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
8440connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
8441
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008442It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
8443will eventually disappear.
8444
8445
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084468.2.2. TCP log format
8447---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008448
8449The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
8450is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
8451information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
8452counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
8453emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
8454environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
8455the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
8456sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008457specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
8458not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
8459fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
8460marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008461
8462 Example :
8463 frontend fnt
8464 mode tcp
8465 option tcplog
8466 log global
8467 default_backend bck
8468
8469 backend bck
8470 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8471
8472 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
8473 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
8474 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
8475
8476 Field Format Extract from the example above
8477 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
8478 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
8479 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
8480 4 frontend_name fnt
8481 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
8482 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
8483 7 bytes_read* 212
8484 8 termination_state --
8485 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
8486 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8487
8488Detailed fields description :
8489 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008490 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8491 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8492 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8493 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8494 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008495
8496 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008497 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8498 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8499 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008500
8501 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
8502 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
8503 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
8504 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
8505
8506 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8507 and processed the connection.
8508
8509 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8510 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8511 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
8512 applications.
8513
8514 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8515 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8516 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8517 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
8518 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
8519
8520 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8521 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8522 See "Timers" below for more details.
8523
8524 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8525 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8526 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
8527 "Timers" below for more details.
8528
8529 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8530 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8531 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8532 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8533 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8534 details.
8535
8536 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8537 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8538 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8539 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8540 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8541
8542 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8543 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8544 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8545 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8546 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8547 for more details.
8548
8549 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8550 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8551 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8552 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8553 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008554 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008555
8556 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8557 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8558 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8559 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8560 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8561 caused by a denial of service attack.
8562
8563 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8564 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8565 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8566 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8567 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8568 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8569 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8570 denial of service attack.
8571
8572 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8573 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8574 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8575 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8576 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8577 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8578 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8579 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
8580 be processed than on other servers.
8581
8582 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8583 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8584 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8585 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8586 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8587 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8588 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8589 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8590 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8591 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8592 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8593 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8594 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8595
8596 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8597 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8598 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8599 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8600 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8601 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8602 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8603 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8604
8605 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8606 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8607 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8608 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8609 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8610 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8611 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8612 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8613 occurs.
8614
8615
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086168.2.3. HTTP log format
8617----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008618
8619The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
8620is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
8621the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
8622are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
8623emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
8624generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
8625"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
8626which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008627frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
8628is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008629
8630Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
8631slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
8632with a star ('*') after the field name below.
8633
8634 Example :
8635 frontend http-in
8636 mode http
8637 option httplog
8638 log global
8639 default_backend bck
8640
8641 backend static
8642 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8643
8644 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8645 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8646 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008647 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008648
8649 Field Format Extract from the example above
8650 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
8651 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
8652 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
8653 4 frontend_name http-in
8654 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
8655 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
8656 7 status_code 200
8657 8 bytes_read* 2750
8658 9 captured_request_cookie -
8659 10 captured_response_cookie -
8660 11 termination_state ----
8661 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
8662 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8663 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
8664 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
8665 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008666
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008667
8668Detailed fields description :
8669 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008670 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8671 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8672 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8673 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8674 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008675
8676 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008677 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8678 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8679 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008680
8681 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
8682 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
8683 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
8684 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
8685 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
8686
8687 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8688 and processed the connection.
8689
8690 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8691 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8692 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
8693
8694 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8695 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8696 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8697 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
8698 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
8699 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
8700
8701 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
8702 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
8703 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
8704 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
8705 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
8706 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
8707
8708 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8709 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8710 See "Timers" below for more details.
8711
8712 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8713 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8714 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
8715 below for more details.
8716
8717 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
8718 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
8719 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
8720 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
8721 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
8722 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
8723 for more details.
8724
8725 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8726 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8727 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8728 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8729 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8730 details.
8731
8732 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
8733 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
8734 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
8735
8736 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
8737 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
8738 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
8739 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
8740 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
8741 overflowing.
8742
8743 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
8744 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
8745 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
8746 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
8747 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
8748 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
8749 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
8750 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8751
8752 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
8753 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
8754 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
8755 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
8756 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
8757 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
8758 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
8759 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8760
8761 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8762 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8763 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
8764 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
8765 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
8766 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
8767 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
8768
8769 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8770 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8771 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
8772 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
8773 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008774 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008775 system.
8776
8777 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8778 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8779 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8780 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8781 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8782 caused by a denial of service attack.
8783
8784 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8785 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8786 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8787 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8788 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8789 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8790 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8791 denial of service attack.
8792
8793 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8794 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8795 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8796 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8797 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8798 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8799 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8800 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
8801 processed than on other servers.
8802
8803 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8804 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8805 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8806 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8807 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8808 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8809 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8810 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8811 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8812 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8813 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8814 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8815 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8816
8817 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8818 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8819 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8820 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8821 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8822 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8823 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8824 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8825
8826 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8827 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8828 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8829 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8830 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8831 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8832 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8833 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8834 occurs.
8835
8836 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
8837 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
8838 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
8839 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
8840 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
8841 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
8842 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
8843 cookies" below for more details.
8844
8845 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
8846 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
8847 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
8848 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
8849 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
8850 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
8851 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
8852 and cookies" below for more details.
8853
8854 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
8855 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
8856 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
8857 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
8858 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
8859 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
8860 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
8861 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
8862
8863
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010088648.2.4 Custom log format
8865-----------------------
8866
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008867The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
8868mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008869
8870HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
8871Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
8872separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
8873prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
8874
8875Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
8876variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
8877string formats ("Q").
8878
8879Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
8880HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
8881
8882Flags are :
8883 * Q: quote a string
8884
8885 Example:
8886
8887 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
8888 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
8889
8890At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
8891
8892 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01008893 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008894
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008895the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008896
8897 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01008898 %ms\ %f\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008899 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
8900
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008901and the default TCP format is defined this way :
8902
8903 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
8904 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
8905
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008906Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
8907
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008908 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
8909 | H | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
8910 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
8911 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
8912 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
8913 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
8914 | | %Ci | client_ip | string |
8915 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +01008916 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | string |
8917 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008918 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
8919 | * | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
8920 | * | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
8921 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
8922 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
8923 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
8924 | | %b | backend_name | string |
8925 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
8926 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
8927 | * | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
8928 | * | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
8929 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
8930 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
8931 | * | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
8932 | * | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
8933 | * | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
8934 | * | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
8935 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
8936 | * | %r | http_request | string |
8937 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
8938 | | %s | server_name | string |
8939 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
8940 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
8941 | * | %st | status_code | numeric |
8942 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01008943 | * | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008944 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008945
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008946*: mode httplog only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008947
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089488.3. Advanced logging options
8949-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008950
8951Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
8952just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
8953options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
8954for more information about their usage.
8955
8956
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089578.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
8958------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008959
8960It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
8961haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
8962commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
8963monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
8964ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
8965
8966 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
8967 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
8968 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
8969 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
8970
8971 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
8972 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
8973 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
8974 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
8975 such as other load-balancers.
8976
8977 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
8978 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
8979 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
8980
8981
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089828.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
8983----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008984
8985The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
8986what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
8987or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
8988"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
8989just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
8990log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
8991after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
8992is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
8993with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
8994with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
8995
8996
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
8998------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008999
9000Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
9001for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
9002"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
9003retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
9004raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
9005a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
9006file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
9007you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
9008"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
9009
9010
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090118.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
9012--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009013
9014Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
9015multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
9016them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
9017"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
9018logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
9019error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
9020and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
9021too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
9022useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
9023alternative.
9024
9025
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090268.4. Timing events
9027------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009028
9029Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
9030reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
9031the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
9032frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
9033mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
9034
9035 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
9036 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
9037 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
9038 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
9039 the client closes prematurely or times out.
9040
9041 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
9042 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
9043 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
9044 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
9045 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
9046
9047 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
9048 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
9049 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
9050 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
9051 connection never established.
9052
9053 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
9054 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
9055 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
9056 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
9057 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
9058 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
9059 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
9060 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
9061 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
9062 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
9063 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
9064
9065 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
9066 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
9067 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
9068 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
9069 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
9070
9071 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
9072
9073 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
9074 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
9075 negative.
9076
9077These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
9078protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
9079that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009080due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009081close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
9082session has been aborted on timeout.
9083
9084Most common cases :
9085
9086 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9087 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
9088 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
9089 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
9090 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
9091 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
9092 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
9093 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
9094 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02009095 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
9096 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
9097 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009098
9099 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9100 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
9101 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
9102 of ms on remote networks.
9103
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009104 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
9105 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
9106 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009107
9108 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
9109 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
9110 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
9111 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
9112 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
9113 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
9114 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
9115 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
9116 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
9117 to the server until another one is released.
9118
9119Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
9120
9121 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
9122 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
9123 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
9124
9125 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
9126 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
9127 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
9128
9129 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
9130 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
9131 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
9132 flags.
9133
9134 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
9135 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
9136 Check the session termination flags, then check the
9137 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
9138 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
9139 the client connection was maintained open.
9140
9141 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
9142 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
9143 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
9144 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
9145
9146
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091478.5. Session state at disconnection
9148-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009149
9150TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
9151"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
91522-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
9153each of which has a special meaning :
9154
9155 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
9156 session to terminate :
9157
9158 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
9159
9160 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
9161 server explicitly refused it.
9162
9163 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
9164 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
9165 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
9166 error in server response which might have caused information leak
9167 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
9168 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
9169
9170 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
9171 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
9172 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
9173 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
9174 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
9175
9176 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
9177 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
9178 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
9179 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
9180 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
9181
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +09009182 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
9183 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
9184
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +02009185 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
9186
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009187 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
9188 send or receive data.
9189
9190 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
9191 send or receive data.
9192
9193 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
9194 with nothing left in the buffers.
9195
9196 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
9197
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01009198 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009199 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
9200
9201 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
9202 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
9203 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
9204 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
9205 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
9206
9207 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
9208 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
9209
9210 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
9211 server (HTTP only).
9212
9213 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
9214
9215 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
9216 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
9217 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
9218
9219 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
9220 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
9221 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
9222
9223 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
9224
9225 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
9226 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
9227
9228 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
9229 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
9230 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
9231
9232 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
9233 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02009234 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
9235 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009236
9237 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
9238 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
9239 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
9240 another server.
9241
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009242 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009243 server.
9244
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009245 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
9246 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
9247 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
9248 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9249
9250 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
9251 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
9252 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
9253 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9254
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +02009255 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
9256 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
9257 "use-server" rule).
9258
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009259 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9260
9261 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
9262 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
9263
9264 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
9265
9266 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
9267 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
9268 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
9269
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009270 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
9271 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
9272 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
9273 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
9274 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
9275
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009276 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
9277
9278 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
9279 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
9280
9281 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
9282
9283 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9284
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009285The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
9286was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009287helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
9288starvation, attacks, etc...
9289
9290The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
9291alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
9292easier finding and understanding.
9293
9294 Flags Reason
9295
9296 -- Normal termination.
9297
9298 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
9299 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
9300 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
9301 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
9302
9303 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
9304 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
9305 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
9306 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
9307 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
9308 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009309
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009310 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9311 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
9312 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
9313
9314 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
9315 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
9316 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
9317
9318 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
9319 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
9320 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
9321 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
9322 the server takes too long to respond.
9323
9324 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
9325 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
9326 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
9327 long a time to respond.
9328
9329 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
9330 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
9331 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
9332 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
9333 and the client.
9334
9335 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
9336 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
9337 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
9338 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
9339 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
9340 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
9341
9342 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
9343 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009344 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
9345 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
9346 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
9347 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009348
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009349 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009350 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
9351 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
9352 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
9353 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
9354 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
9355
9356 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
9357 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
9358 503 or 504 here.
9359
9360 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
9361 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
9362 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
9363 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
9364 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
9365
9366 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9367 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009368 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009369 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
9370 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
9371
9372 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
9373 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
9374 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
9375 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
9376 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
9377 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
9378 between haproxy and the server.
9379
9380 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
9381 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
9382 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
9383 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
9384 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
9385 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
9386 solution is to fix the application.
9387
9388 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
9389 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
9390 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
9391 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
9392 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
9393 external attacks.
9394
9395 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
9396 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
9397 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
9398 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
9399 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
9400
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009401 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
9402 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
9403 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
9404 the client.
9405
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009406 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
9407 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
9408 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
9409 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009410 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
9411 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
9412 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
9413 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
9414 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009415
9416 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
9417 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
9418 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
9419 returned an HTTP 403 error.
9420
9421 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
9422 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
9423 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
9424 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
9425
9426 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
9427 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
9428 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
9429 only be solved by proper system tuning.
9430
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009431The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
9432persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
9433important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
9434re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
9435
9436 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
9437
9438 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9439 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
9440 set on a GET request.
9441
9442 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
9443 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
9444 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
9445 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
9446
9447 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
9448 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
9449 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
9450
9451 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9452 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
9453 already got a cookie.
9454
9455 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9456 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
9457 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
9458 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
9459 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
9460
9461 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9462 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9463 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9464
9465 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
9466 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9467 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9468
9469 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
9470 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
9471
9472 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
9473 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
9474 then advertised in the response.
9475
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094778.6. Non-printable characters
9478-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009479
9480In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
9481consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
9482converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
9483prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
9484being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
9485escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
9486is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
9487'}' when logging headers.
9488
9489Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
9490issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
9491containing spaces is "User-Agent".
9492
9493Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
9494the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
9495performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
9496
9497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094988.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
9499---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009500
9501Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
9502achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009503section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009504cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
9505the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
9506the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009507locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009508not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
9509user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
9510a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
9511wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
9512
9513 Examples :
9514 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
9515 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
9516
9517 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
9518 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
9519
9520
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095218.8. Capturing HTTP headers
9522---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009523
9524Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
9525proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
9526the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
9527server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
9528
9529Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
9530response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009531section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009532
9533It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009534time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
9535appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009536are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
9537and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
9538follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
9539request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
9540in the logs.
9541
9542 Example :
9543 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
9544 listen proxy-out
9545 mode http
9546 option httplog
9547 option logasap
9548 log global
9549 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
9550
9551 # log the name of the virtual server
9552 capture request header Host len 20
9553
9554 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
9555 capture request header Content-Length len 10
9556
9557 # log the beginning of the referrer
9558 capture request header Referer len 20
9559
9560 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
9561 capture response header Server len 20
9562
9563 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
9564 capture response header Content-Length len 10
9565
9566 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
9567 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
9568
9569 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
9570 capture response header Via len 20
9571
9572 # log the URL location during a redirection
9573 capture response header Location len 20
9574
9575 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
9576 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
9577 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9578 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
9579 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
9580
9581 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9582 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9583 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9584 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009585 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009586
9587 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9588 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9589 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9590 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
9591 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009592 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009593
9594
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095958.9. Examples of logs
9596---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009597
9598These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
9599them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
9600reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
9601
9602 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
9603 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9604 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9605
9606 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
9607 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
9608
9609 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
9610 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
9611 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9612
9613 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
9614 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
9615
9616 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
9617 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9618 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9619
9620 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009621 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009622 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
9623 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
9624
9625 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
9626 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
9627 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
9628
9629 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
9630 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009631 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009632 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
9633 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
9634 to return the 502 and not the server.
9635
9636 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009637 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009638
9639 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
9640 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
9641 Nothing was sent to any server.
9642
9643 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
9644 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
9645
9646 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
9647 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
9648 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
9649 send a 408 return code to the client.
9650
9651 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
9652 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
9653
9654 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
9655 5 seconds ("c----").
9656
9657 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
9658 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009659 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009660
9661 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009662 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009663 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
9664 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
9665 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
9666 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
9667 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009668
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009669
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096709. Statistics and monitoring
9671----------------------------
9672
9673It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
9674mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
9675CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
9676Unix socket.
9677
9678
96799.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009680---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009681
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01009682The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
9683page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
9684
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009685 0. pxname: proxy name
9686 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
9687 for server)
9688 2. qcur: current queued requests
9689 3. qmax: max queued requests
9690 4. scur: current sessions
9691 5. smax: max sessions
9692 6. slim: sessions limit
9693 7. stot: total sessions
9694 8. bin: bytes in
9695 9. bout: bytes out
9696 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009697 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009698 12. ereq: request errors
9699 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009700 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009701 15. wretr: retries (warning)
9702 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01009703 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009704 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
9705 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
9706 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
9707 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
9708 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
9709 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
9710 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
9711 25. qlimit: queue limit
9712 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
9713 27. iid: unique proxy id
9714 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
9715 29. throttle: warm up status
9716 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
9717 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009718 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02009719 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
9720 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
9721 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009722 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009723 UNK -> unknown
9724 INI -> initializing
9725 SOCKERR -> socket error
9726 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
9727 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
9728 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
9729 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
9730 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
9731 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
9732 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
9733 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
9734 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
9735 disable-on-404
9736 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
9737 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
9738 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009739 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
9740 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009741 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
9742 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
9743 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
9744 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
9745 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
9746 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009747 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
9748 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
9749 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
9750 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009751 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
9752 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009753
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009754
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097559.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009756-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009757
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009758The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009759must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
9760is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
9761a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
9762risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
9763followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
9764given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
9765then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
9766to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009767
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009768It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
9769on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
9770own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009771
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009772clear counters
9773 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
9774 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
9775 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
9776 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
9777 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9778
9779clear counters all
9780 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
9781 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
9782 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
9783
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009784clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
9785 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
9786
9787 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
9788 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
9789 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
9790 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
9791 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
9792 later after the session ends is usual enough.
9793
9794 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
9795
9796 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
9797 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
9798 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
9799 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
9800 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
9801 the ACLs :
9802
9803 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9804 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9805 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9806 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9807 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9808 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9809
9810 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +09009811 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
9812 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009813
9814 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009815 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009816 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009817 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9818 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9819 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9820 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009821
9822 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9823
9824 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009825 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009826 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9827 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009828 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9829 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9830 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009831
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +02009832disable frontend <frontend>
9833 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
9834 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
9835 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
9836 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
9837 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
9838 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
9839 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
9840 on the stats page.
9841
9842 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
9843 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9844
9845 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9846 level "admin".
9847
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009848disable server <backend>/<server>
9849 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
9850 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
9851 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
9852 during the maintenance.
9853
9854 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
9855 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
9856
9857 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009858 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009859
9860 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9861 level "admin".
9862
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +02009863enable frontend <frontend>
9864 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
9865 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
9866 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
9867 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
9868 which was disabled.
9869
9870 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
9871 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9872
9873 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9874 level "admin".
9875
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009876enable server <backend>/<server>
9877 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
9878 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
9879
9880 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009881 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009882
9883 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9884 level "admin".
9885
9886get weight <backend>/<server>
9887 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
9888 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
9889 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
9890 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
9891 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009892 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009893
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009894help
9895 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
9896 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009897
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009898prompt
9899 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
9900 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
9901 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
9902 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
9903 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
9904 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
9905 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
9906 command.
9907
9908quit
9909 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009910
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +02009911set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
9912 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any non-null
9913 positive value is allowed, but setting values larger than the global maxconn
9914 does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections were
9915 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
9916 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
9917 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
9918 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9919
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +02009920set maxconn global <maxconn>
9921 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
9922 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
9923 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
9924 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
9925 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
9926 setting.
9927
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +02009928set rate-limit connections global <value>
9929 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
9930 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
9931 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
9932 is passed in number of connections per second.
9933
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009934set timeout cli <delay>
9935 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
9936 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
9937 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
9938
9939set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
9940 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
9941 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
9942 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
9943 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
9944 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
9945 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
9946 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
9947 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
9948 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
9949 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
9950 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
9951 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
9952 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009953 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009954
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009955show errors [<iid>]
9956 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
9957 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009958 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
9959 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
9960 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009961
9962 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
9963 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
9964 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
9965 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
9966 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
9967 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
9968 are reported too.
9969
9970 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
9971 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
9972 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
9973 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
9974 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
9975 code.
9976
9977 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
9978 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
9979 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
9980 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
9981 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
9982 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
9983 line.
9984
9985 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009986 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9987 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009988 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
9989 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
9990
9991 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
9992 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
9993 00038 Location: blah\r\n
9994 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
9995 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
9996 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
9997 00204+ minal\r\n
9998 00211 \r\n
9999
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010000 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010001 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
10002 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
10003 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
10004 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
10005 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
10006 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010007
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010008show info
10009 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
10010
10011show sess
10012 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010013 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
10014 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10015
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010010016show sess <id>
10017 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
10018 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10019 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
10020 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
10021 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
10022 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010023
10024show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
10025 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
10026 possible to dump only selected items :
10027 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
10028 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
10029 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
10030 for example:
10031 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
10032 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
10033 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
10034
10035 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010036 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
10037 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010038 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
10039 Release_date: 2009/09/23
10040 Nbproc: 1
10041 Process_num: 1
10042 (...)
10043
10044 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
10045 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
10046 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
10047 (...)
10048 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
10049
10050 $
10051
10052 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
10053 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
10054 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
10055 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010056 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010057
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010058show table
10059 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
10060 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
10061 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
10062 entries currently in use.
10063
10064 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010065 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010066 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
10067 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010068
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010069show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010070 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
10071 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
10072 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010073 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
10074
10075 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
10076 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
10077 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
10078 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
10079 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
10080
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010081 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10082 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10083 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10084 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10085 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10086 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10087
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010088
10089 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010090 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
10091 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010092
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010093 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010094 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010095 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010096 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10097 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10098 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10099 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010100
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010101 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010102 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010103 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10104 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010105
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010106 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
10107 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010108 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010109 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10110 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010111
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010112 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
10113 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010114 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010115 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10116 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
10117
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010118 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
10119 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
10120 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
10121 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
10122 time goes, the average event rate drops.
10123
10124 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
10125 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
10126 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010127 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
10128 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010129 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
10130 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020010131
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010132shutdown frontend <frontend>
10133 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
10134 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
10135 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
10136 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
10137 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
10138 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
10139 once it is terminated.
10140
10141 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10142 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10143
10144 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10145 level "admin".
10146
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020010147shutdown session <id>
10148 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
10149 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10150 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
10151 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
10152 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
10153 flag in the logs.
10154
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020010155shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
10156 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
10157 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
10158 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
10159 'K' flag in the logs.
10160
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010161/*
10162 * Local variables:
10163 * fill-column: 79
10164 * End:
10165 */